Chevrolet Automobile 2010 Aveo Sedan User Manual

2010 Chevrolet Aveo Owner Manual M  
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Seats and Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Driving Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Features and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Canadian Owners  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
A French language copy of this manual can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer or from:  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en français  
auprès du concessionnaire ou à l'adresse suivante:  
GENERAL MOTORS, GM, the GM Emblem,  
CHEVROLET, the CHEVROLET Emblem, and the  
name AVEO are registered trademarks of General  
Motors.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
1-800-551-4123  
This manual describes features that may or may not  
be on your specific vehicle either because they are  
options that you did not purchase or due to changes  
subsequent to the printing of this owner manual. Please  
refer to the purchase documentation relating to your  
specific vehicle to confirm each of the features found  
on your vehicle. For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
substitute the name General Motors of Canada  
Limitedfor Chevrolet Motor Division wherever it  
appears in this manual.  
Numéro de poste 6438 de langue française  
www.helminc.com  
Index  
To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the  
index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list  
of what is in the manual and the page number where it  
can be found.  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 20858877 B Second Printing  
©2009 General Motors. All Rights Reserved.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A circle with a slash  
through it is a safety  
symbol which means  
Do Not,” “Do not do  
this,or Do not let this  
happen.”  
Safety Warnings and Symbols  
Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this  
manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or  
reduce them.  
Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk  
which will result in serious injury or death.  
Warning or Caution indicates a hazard that could result  
in injury or death.  
Vehicle Symbols  
The vehicle has components and labels that use  
symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with  
the text describing the operation or information relating  
to a specific component, control, message, gauge,  
or indicator.  
WARNING:  
{
These mean there is something that could hurt  
you or other people.  
M : This symbol is shown when you need to see your  
owner manual for additional instructions or information.  
Notice: This means there is something that could  
result in property or vehicle damage. This would not  
be covered by the vehicle's warranty.  
* : This symbol is shown when you need to see a  
service manual for additional instructions or information.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
. : Fuel Gauge  
Here are some additional symbols that may be found on  
the vehicle and what they mean. For more information  
on the symbol, refer to the index.  
+ : Fuses  
i : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
j : LATCH System Child Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
I : Cruise Control  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
} : Power  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
F : Traction Control  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
# : Fog Lamps  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1 In Brief  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Portable Audio Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Trunk Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7  
Second Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Head Restraint Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Sensing System for Passenger Airbag . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Outlet Adjustment on page 419.  
B. Instrument Panel Cluster on page 422.  
C. Clock on page 415.  
Initial Drive Information  
This section provides a brief overview about some of  
the important features that may or may not be on your  
specific vehicle.  
D. Hood Release on page 612.  
E. Horn on page 43.  
For more detailed information, refer to each of the  
features which can be found later in this owner manual.  
F. Audio System(s) on page 439.  
G. Climate Control System on page 416.  
H. Ashtray. See Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter on  
Starting the Engine  
The vehicle has a Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. It assists in starting the engine and protects  
components. If the ignition key is turned to START  
and then released when the engine begins cranking,  
the engine will continue cranking for a few seconds  
or until the engine starts. If the engine does not start  
and the key is held in START, cranking will be stopped  
after 15 seconds to prevent damage. To prevent gear  
damage, cranking is not allowed if the engine is  
running. Engine cranking can be stopped by turning  
the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/OFF.  
See Starting the Engine on page 319.  
page 415  
.
I. Cupholders on page 336.  
J. Cigarette Lighter. See Ashtray(s) and Cigarette  
Lighter on page 415.  
K. Hazard Warning Flashers on page 43.  
L. Glove Box on page 336.  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press 3 to sound the panic alarm on the hatchback  
model. Press any of the buttons on the transmitter to  
turn off the alarm.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
The RKE transmitter is used to remotely lock and  
unlock the doors from up to 20 m (65 feet) away from  
the vehicle.  
The LED light (A) on the transmitter flashes when the  
buttons on the transmitter are pressed. If the light does  
not flash the transmitter battery needs to be replaced.  
See Keys on page 32 and Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 34.  
Door Locks  
From the outside, lock or unlock the door using the key  
or the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
From the inside, all of the doors can be locked and  
unlocked by pushing or pulling the manual door lock on  
each door.  
On vehicles equipped with the central door unlocking  
system, lock or unlock all the doors from the inside  
using the driver door lock switch.  
Hatchback  
Sedan  
For more information see:  
Press K to unlock all of the doors.  
Press Q to lock all of the doors.  
.
Door Locks on page 36.  
.
Central Door Unlocking System on page 37.  
Press V and hold for approximately one second to  
open the trunk on the sedan model.  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The liftgate can also be locked or unlocked by the  
central door unlocking system.  
Liftgate  
To unlock the liftgate on the hatchback model from  
outside the vehicle, use the key in the lock cylinder or  
use the RKE transmitter, if equipped.  
For more information see Liftgate (Hatchback) on  
page 310  
.
Trunk Release  
The vehicle may have a  
release button located on  
the driver door. Press it to  
open the trunk.  
The handle is located above the right side of the license  
plate. Pull the handle toward you and raise the liftgate.  
To lock the liftgate, use the key or the RKE transmitter,  
if equipped.  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle may have  
a trunk release lever  
located on the outboard  
side of the driver seat.  
Pull the lever to open the  
trunk.  
Power Windows  
For more information see Trunk on page 38.  
Windows  
On vehicles with power windows, the switches for all  
windows are located on the driver door armrest. Each  
passenger door has a switch for its own window.  
Manual Windows  
Use the window crank to open and close each window.  
The rear windows do not open fully.  
The ignition must be in ON/RUN to use the power  
windows. To lower the window, press and hold the  
switch. To raise the window, lift up on the switch.  
Release the switch when the window reaches the  
desired level.  
For more information see Manual Windows on  
page 313  
.
For more information see Power Windows on  
page 313  
.
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Seat Adjustment  
Turn the knob located on  
the outboard side of the  
seat to adjust the height  
of the driver seat cushion.  
Manual Seats  
1. Lift the bar under the  
front of the seat to  
unlock it.  
Turn the knob forward to raise the seat and rearward to  
lower it.  
2. Slide the seat to the desired position and release  
the bar.  
Push and pull on the seat to make sure it is locked into  
place.  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Lumbar  
Reclining Seatbacks  
Move the adjustment  
lever, located on the  
outboard side of the  
seatback, up or down to  
one of three positions to  
increase or decrease the  
lumbar support.  
The highest position provides the most support and the  
lowest position provides the least support.  
This lever is located on the outboard side of the front  
seats.  
1. Lift the recline lever.  
2. Move the seatback to the desired position then  
release the lever to lock the seatback in place.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked in place.  
See Reclining Seatbacks on page 26.  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Second Row Seats  
Safety Belt  
The rear seatbacks can be folded down to increase  
cargo space.  
For detailed instructions see Rear Seat Operation  
(Sedan) on page 28 or Rear Seat Operation  
(Hatchback) on page 210.  
Head Restraint Adjustment  
The vehicle's front seats have adjustable head  
restraints in the outboard seating positions.  
Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants  
are installed and adjusted properly.  
For more information see Head Restraints on  
page 22  
.
Refer to the following sections for important information  
on how to use safety belts properly.  
.
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 214.  
.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 219.  
.
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 228.  
.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 244  
.
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sensing System for Passenger  
Airbag  
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and seatmounted side  
impact airbag (if equipped) under certain conditions.  
The driver airbags are not affected by this.  
Mirror Adjustment  
Exterior Mirrors  
Manual Outside Mirrors  
The passenger airbag status indicator will be visible,  
near the clock, located in the center of the instrument  
panel when the vehicle is started.  
United States  
Canada  
The control for the outside manual mirrors are located  
next to each mirror.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 265 for  
important information.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return to its original position.  
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For more information, see:  
Power Outside Mirrors  
.
Outside Power Mirrors on page 335.  
The control is located on  
the instrument panel, left  
of the steering wheel.  
.
Outside Manual Mirrors on page 334.  
Interior Mirror  
Hold the mirror in the center to move it up or down  
and side to side. Adjust the mirror to avoid glare from  
the headlamps behind you. Push the tab forward for  
daytime use and pull it for nighttime use.  
See Manual Rearview Mirror on page 334.  
The ignition must be turned to ON/RUN to adjust the  
mirrors.  
1. Select the mirror by moving the selector switch  
to L for the driver side mirror or R for the  
passenger side.  
2. Press one of the four arrows located on the control  
pad to move the mirror to the desired direction.  
1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Steering Wheel Adjustment  
Interior Lighting  
The tilt wheel lever is  
located under the steering  
column, slightly to the left.  
Dome Lamp  
The vehicle has a dome lamp located in the overhead  
console.  
Move the switch to the following positions:  
ON: The light comes on and stays on.  
O : The light comes on when a door is opened. The  
light turns off when all the doors are closed.  
OFF: The light remains off even when a door is  
opened.  
Be sure all doors and trunk lid or hatch are completely  
closed or the battery may drain.  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down.  
For more information about interior lighting, see:  
.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down into a  
comfortable position.  
Dome Lamp on page 413.  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the wheel in place.  
See Tilt Wheel on page 43.  
1-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
;: Turns on the parking lamps, together with the  
taillamps, license plate lamp, and instrument panel  
lights.  
Exterior Lighting  
OFF: Turns all the lamps off, except the Daytime  
Running Lamps (DRL).  
For more information, see:  
.
Exterior Lamps on page 411.  
.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 412.  
.
Fog Lamps on page 412.  
Uplevel shown, Base similar  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the exterior lamps.  
3: Turns on the headlamps and other exterior lamps.  
The headlamps automatically turn off when the ignition  
key is turned to LOCK/OFF or ACC/ACCESSORY.  
1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The lever is located on the right side of the steering  
column. The ignition must be turned to ON/RUN to  
operate the windshield wipers.  
Windshield Wiper/Washer  
HI: Fast wipes.  
LO: Slow wipes.  
INT: Move to this position for a delayed wiping cycle.  
Turn the band on the windshield wiper toward FAST or  
SLOW for a shorter or longer delay between wipes. The  
wiper speed can only be adjusted when the lever is in  
the INT position.  
OFF: Turns the windshield wipers off.  
Sedan shown  
Misting Function  
Move the lever toward INT for a single wiping cycle.  
Hold it there until the windshield wipers start; then let  
go. For several wipes, hold the band toward INT longer.  
Windshield Washer  
Pull the windshield washer/wiper lever toward you to  
spray washer fluid on the windshield.  
See Windshield Wipers on page 46 and  
Windshield Washer on page 47. For vehicles  
with a Rear Window Wiper/Washer, see Rear Window  
Wiper/Washer on page 48.  
Hatchback shown  
1-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
For vehicles with these climate control systems, the  
heating, cooling, and ventilation can be controlled for  
the vehicle.  
Climate Control System with Heater Only  
A. Temperature Control D. Rear Window Defogger  
B. Fan Control  
E. Outside Air/Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
Climate Control System with Heater and Air  
Conditioning  
See Climate Control System on page 416.  
A. Temperature Control D. Air Conditioning (A/C)  
B. Fan Control  
E. Air Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery  
Mode Control  
F. Rear Window  
Defogger  
1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission  
Automatic Transmission  
Hold Mode  
If the vehicle's transmission has hold mode, you can  
select this mode to allow the automatic transmission to  
stay in a specific gear range. Select hold mode to help  
the vehicle maintain traction on slippery road surfaces,  
such as snow, mud, or ice.  
Press the HOLD button on the shift lever console to turn  
on hold mode. Press the button again to turn off hold  
mode, and return to normal automatic transmission  
operation.  
1-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When Hold Mode is selected in D4 (Drive), the  
transmission is held in 3 (Third) gear, which locks  
out D4 (Drive). This allows for engine braking when  
slowing from higher speeds.  
Five-Speed Manual Transmission  
UpShift Light  
Vehicles equipped with  
When Hold Mode is selected in 2 (Second), the  
transmission will start in 2 (Second) gear instead  
of 1 (First), helping to reduce wheel spin when starting  
out on slippery surface such as snow, mud or ice.  
a manual transmission  
may have an up-shift light.  
This light indicates when  
to shift to the next higher  
gear for better fuel  
Since selecting Hold Mode in D4 (Drive) locks the  
transmission in 3 (Third), and prevents downshifts  
to 2 (Second) or 1 (First), acceleration from a stop  
or near stop on dry pavement will be slower than  
expected. Hold Mode should not be selected during  
these situations.  
economy.  
For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly and shift  
when the light comes on, if weather, road, and traffic  
conditions allow.  
See Automatic Transmission Operation on page 323.  
It is normal for the light to go on and off if the  
accelerator position changes quickly. Ignore the light  
during downshifts.  
Cold Weather Shifting  
When operating the vehicle in severe cold conditions,  
the transmission may be prevented from shifting  
into D4 gear until the transmission fluid has warmed  
up to it's operational temperature.  
Reverse Lockout  
The manual transmission is equipped with a lock  
ring to prevent shifting into R (Reverse). To shift into  
R (Reverse), press down the clutch pedal, lift up the ring  
on the shift lever and shift into R (Reverse). Let up on  
the clutch pedal slowly while pressing the accelerator  
pedal.  
See Manual Transmission Operation on page 326.  
1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the system is on, press and release O to mute  
the system. Press and release O again to turn the  
sound back on.  
Vehicle Features  
Radio(s)  
BAND: Press to choose FM, AM, or XM  
(if equipped).  
u SEEK: Press to seek the next radio station with a  
strong signal in the selected band.  
t SEEK: Press to seek the previous radio station with  
a strong signal in the selected band.  
[ TUNE: Press to go to the next station manually.  
r TUNE: Press to go to the previous station manually.  
SCAN/AST: Press to scan radio stations. Press and  
hold to use Auto Store.  
CD/AUX: Press to play a CD when listening to the  
radio. CDP appears on the display when the CD player  
has been selected. The CD symbol will appear on the  
display when a CD is loaded. Press CD/AUX while a  
CD is playing to pause the CD. PAUSE flashes on the  
display. Press CD/AUX again to start playing the CD.  
Press CD/AUX to play a CD when listening to the audio  
contents from other device (AUX mode). CDP appears  
on the display when the CD player has been selected.  
The CD symbol will appear on the display when a CD is  
loaded.  
Radio with CD shown  
O : Press and release to turn the system on. Press and  
hold this knob for more than two seconds to turn the  
system off.  
Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
1-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press to play a CD while a portable audio device is  
playing. Press CD/AUX a second time for the system to  
begin playing audio from the connected portable audio  
player. The portable audio device continues playing  
until it is turned off.  
Satellite Radio  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM satellite radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound.  
For more information about these and other radio  
features, see Audio System(s) on page 439.  
A fee is required to receive the XM service.  
For more information, refer to:  
Storing a Favorite Station  
A maximum of 36 stations can be programmed as  
favorites using the six pushbuttons positioned below  
the radio station frequency labels and by using the  
radio favorites page button (FAV button). Press the  
FAV button to go through up to six pages of favorites,  
each having six favorite stations available per page.  
If Automatic Store is used, then four pages of favorites  
are available. Each page of favorites can contain any  
combination of AM, FM, or XM(if equipped) stations.  
.
www.xmradio.com or call 1-800-929-2100 (U.S.)  
.
www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677 (Canada)  
See XM Satellite Radio Serviceunder AM-FM Radio  
on page 440 and Radio with CD on page 445.  
Portable Audio Devices  
This vehicle may have a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary  
input jack, located on the lower right side of the audio  
faceplate. External devices such as iPod®, laptop  
computers, MP3 players, etc. can be connected to the  
3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input jack using a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) input jack cable.  
See Storing a Favorite Stationunder AM-FM Radio on  
page 440 and Radio with CD on page 445.  
See Using the Auxiliary Input Jackunder AM-FM  
Radio on page 440 and Radio with CD on page 445.  
1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
+ VOLUME : Press the toggle bar located below  
the + VOLUME to adjust the volume.  
Steering Wheel Controls  
MODE: Press and release this button multiple times  
to cycle through the audio playback options that are  
available on the vehicle.  
SEEK: Press and release to go to the next preset  
station, or CD track. Press and hold for a long time to  
go to the next AM, FM, or XM station, or to fast forward  
through CD tracks.  
For more information, see Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls on page 464.  
Trip Computer  
Front View of the Steering Side View of the Volume  
Wheel Controls  
Control  
The vehicle may have trip computer, it provides the  
driver with driving information such as the driving  
distance for the remaining fuel, outside temperature,  
average fuel economy, and driving time.  
If the vehicle has this feature, some audio controls can  
be adjusted at the steering wheel.  
The trip computer button is located in the lower right  
area of the tachometer. Each time you press it, the  
display cycles through the available choices.  
PWR: Press and release to turn the system on and off.  
When the system is on, press and release for a short  
time to mute the system. Press and release again to  
turn the sound back on.  
See Trip Computer on page 438.  
1-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control  
Power Outlets  
Accessory power outlets can be used to plug in  
auxiliary electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
The accessory power outlet is located next to the  
parking brake on the center console.  
To use the accessory power outlet, remove the  
protective cap. When not in use, always cover the  
outlet with the protective cap.  
The accessory power outlet is operational when the  
ignition is turned to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.  
See Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 414.  
The cruise control buttons are located on the right side  
of the steering wheel.  
I / O : Press to turn the cruise control on or off.  
RES+: Press to make the vehicle accelerate or resume  
to a previously set speed.  
SET: Press to set the speed or make the vehicle  
decelerate.  
See Cruise Control on page 48.  
1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sunroof  
Performance and Maintenance  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the switch is  
located on the headliner  
between the sun visors  
and can only be operated  
when the ignition is turned  
to ON/RUN.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS).  
The Tire Pressure  
Monitor alerts you when  
a significant reduction in  
pressure occurs in one or  
more of the vehicles tires  
by illuminating the low tire  
pressure warning light on  
the instrument cluster.  
To vent the sunroof, open the sunshade and then press  
and hold the driver side switch. To close, press the  
passenger side switch.  
To fully open the sunroof, press and hold the passenger  
side switch. The sunshade will open with the sunroof.  
To close, press the driver side switch. Manually close  
the sunshade.  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label located on  
the driver side center pillar (B pillar). See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 515. The warning light will remain on  
until the tire pressure is corrected.  
For more information see Sunroof on page 337.  
1-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You may notice during cooler conditions that the low tire  
pressure warning light will appear when the vehicle is  
first started and then turn off as you drive. This may be  
an early indicator that your tire pressures are getting  
low and the tires need to be inflated to the proper  
pressure.  
Engine Oil Life System  
The engine oil life system calculates engine oil life  
based on vehicle use and displays a change engine oil  
light when it is necessary to change the engine oil and  
filter.  
The Tire Pressure Monitor can alert you about low tire  
pressure, but it does not replace normal monthly tire  
maintenance. It is the drivers responsibility to maintain  
correct tire pressures.  
Resetting the Oil Life System  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
2. Fully press and release the accelerator pedal  
three times within five seconds.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 659 and  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 660.  
3. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
See Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hood Release  
To open the hood:  
1. Pull the hood release  
handle inside the  
vehicle. It is located on  
the lower left side of  
the instrument panel.  
2. At the front of the vehicle, lift up on the secondary  
hood release lever, located under the front center  
of the vehicle.  
3. Lift the hood and securely place the hood prop into  
the slot on the inner fender.  
See Hood Release on page 612.  
1-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy  
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some  
driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
U.S.: 1-800-CHEV-USA (1-800-243-8872)  
TTY Users: 1-888-889-2438  
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.  
Canada: 1-800-268-6800  
.
Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.  
As the owner of a new Chevrolet, you are automatically  
enrolled in the Roadside Assistance program. This  
program provides technically trained advisors who are  
available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year, minor repair  
information or towing arrangements.  
.
Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time.  
.
When road and weather conditions are  
appropriate, use cruise control, if equipped.  
.
Always follow posted speed limits or drive more  
slowly when conditions require.  
Roadside Assistance and OnStar  
.
Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.  
If you have a current OnStar subscription, press the  
OnStar button and the current GPS location will be sent  
to an OnStar Advisor who will assess your problem,  
contact Roadside Assistance, and relay exact location  
to get you the help you need.  
.
Combine several trips into a single trip.  
.
Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC  
Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near  
the size.  
.
Online Owner Center  
Follow recommended scheduled maintenance.  
The Online Owner Center is a complimentary service  
that includes online service reminders, vehicle  
maintenance tips, online owner manual, special  
privileges and more.  
Sign up today at: www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
(U.S.) or www.gm.ca (Canada).  
1-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OnStar®  
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle  
Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock, Roadside  
Assistance, TurnbyTurn Navigation and HandsFree  
Calling are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar  
services are available on all vehicles. For more  
information see the OnStar Owner's Guide or visit  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada),  
contact OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR (18884667827)  
or TTY 18772482080, or press Q to speak with an  
OnStar advisor 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
OnStar® uses several innovative technologies and live  
advisors to provide a wide range of safety, security,  
navigation, diagnostics, and calling services.  
For a full description of OnStar services and system  
limitations, see the OnStar Owner's Guide in the  
glove box.  
OnStar service is subject to the OnStar terms and  
conditions included in the OnStar Subscriber  
Information.  
Automatic Crash Response  
In a crash, built in sensors can automatically alert an  
OnStar advisor who is immediately connected to the  
vehicle to see if you need help.  
OnStar service cannot work unless the vehicle is in a  
place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless  
service provider for service in that area. OnStar service  
also cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where  
the wireless service provider OnStar has hired for that  
area has coverage, network capacity and reception  
when the service is needed, and technology that is  
compatible with the OnStar service. Not all services are  
available everywhere, particularly in remote or enclosed  
areas, or at all times.  
How OnStar Service Works  
Q : This blue button connects you to a specially  
trained OnStar advisor to verify your account  
information and to answer questions.  
] : Push this red emergency button to get priority help  
from specially trained OnStar emergency advisors.  
X : Push this button for handsfree, voiceactivated  
calling and to give voice commands for turnbyturn  
navigation.  
1-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The OnStar system can record and transmit vehicle  
information. This information is automatically sent to an  
Your Responsibility  
Increase the volume of the radio if the OnStar advisor  
cannot be heard.  
OnStar call center when Q is pressed, ] is pressed,  
or if the airbags or ACR system deploy. This information  
usually includes the vehicle's GPS location and, in the  
event of a crash, additional information regarding the  
crash that the vehicle was involved in (e.g. the direction  
from which the vehicle was hit). When the virtual  
advisor feature of OnStar hands-free calling is used, the  
vehicle also sends OnStar the vehicle's GPS location  
so they can provide services where it is located.  
If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red, the system  
may not be functioning properly. Press Q and request a  
vehicle diagnostic. If the light appears clear (no light is  
appearing), your OnStar subscription has expired and  
all services have been deactivated. Press Q to confirm  
that the OnStar equipment is active.  
Location information about the vehicle is only available  
if the GPS satellite signals are unobstructed and  
available.  
The vehicle must have a working electrical system,  
including adequate battery power, for the OnStar  
equipment to operate. There are other problems OnStar  
cannot control that may prevent OnStar from providing  
OnStar service at any particular time or place. Some  
examples are damage to important parts of the vehicle  
in a crash, hills, tall buildings, tunnels, weather or  
wireless phone network congestion.  
1-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
1-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2 Seats and Restraint System  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Manual Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . 2-64  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-65  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . 2-70  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Rear Seat Operation (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8  
Rear Seat Operation (Hatchback) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Head Restraints  
The front seats have adjustable head restraints in the  
outboard seating positions.  
WARNING:  
{
With head restraints that are not installed and  
adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that  
occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a  
crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all  
occupants are installed and adjusted properly.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint  
is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head.  
This position reduces the chances of a neck injury in a  
crash.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Push down on the head restraint after the button is  
released to make sure that it is locked in place.  
The head restraints are not designed to be removed.  
The rear seats have head rests that are adjustable up  
and down.  
Pull the head restraint up to raise it. To lower the head  
restraint, press the button, located on the top of the  
seatback, and push the restraint down.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front Seats  
Manual Seats  
WARNING:  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
1. Lift the bar under the front of the seat to unlock it.  
2. Slide the seat to the desired position and release  
the bar.  
3. Push and pull on the seat to make sure it is locked  
into place.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Manual Lumbar  
Turn the knob, located on  
On vehicles with front  
seat manual lumbar,  
the adjustment lever is  
located on the outboard  
side of the seatback.  
the outboard side of the  
seat, to adjust the height  
of the driver seat.  
Turn the knob forward to raise the seat and rearward to  
lower it.  
Move the lever up or down to one of three positions to  
increase or decrease lumbar support.  
The highest position provides the most support and the  
lowest position provides the least support.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reclining Seatbacks  
WARNING:  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
WARNING:  
{
To recline the seatback:  
1. Lift the recline lever.  
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
2. Move the seatback to the desired position, then  
release the lever to lock the seatback in place.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked in place.  
To return the seatback to an upright position:  
1. Lift the lever fully without applying pressure to the  
seatback and the seatback will return to the upright  
position.  
The seats have manual reclining seatbacks. The lever  
is located on the outboard side of the seats.  
2. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in  
motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up,  
the safety belts cannot do their job when reclined  
like this.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will  
not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front  
of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving  
neck or other injuries.  
The lap belt cannot do its job either. In a crash,  
the belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt  
forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones.  
This could cause serious internal injuries.  
For proper protection when the vehicle is in  
motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear the safety belt properly.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if the vehicle is  
moving.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Seats  
Rear Seat Operation (Sedan)  
Folding the Seatbacks  
The rear seatbacks can be folded down to increase  
cargo space.  
To fold down the seatbacks:  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with the safety belts  
still fastened may cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the safety belts and  
return them to their normal stowed position before  
folding a rear seat.  
1. Remove the safety belt strap from the safety belt  
guide by pulling it through the slot.  
2. Push the head restraints all the way down.  
3. Unlatch the center safety belt by pressing the red  
button on the buckle.  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Detach the center safety belt from the mini buckle  
by inserting the ignition key into the slot in the mini  
buckle, pressing the release button, and allowing  
the belt to retract.  
5. Pull up the release knob located on top of either of  
the rear seatbacks.  
6. Fold the rear seatback forward and down.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Unfolding the Seatbacks  
WARNING:  
{
To return the seatback to the upright position:  
1. Hook the safety belts into the safety belt guide.  
A safety belt that is improperly routed, not  
properly attached, or twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The person wearing  
the belt could be seriously injured. After raising  
the rear seatback, always check to be sure that  
the safety belts are properly routed and attached,  
and are not twisted.  
2. Lift the seatback up and push it to its original  
position.  
WARNING:  
{
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
6. Insert the safety belt strap back into the safety belt  
guide.  
Rear Seat Operation (Hatchback)  
Folding the Rear Seats  
3. Push down and rearward firmly on the top of the  
seatbacks until it latches securely in the fully  
upright position.  
The rear seats can be folded to increase cargo space.  
To fold the rear seats:  
4. To reattach the center seat safety belt to the mini  
buckle, pull it from the retractor.  
1. Lower the head restraints completely.  
5. Push the latch plate at the end of the safety belt  
strap into the mini-buckle until the mechanism  
clicks. Make sure the strap is not twisted. The  
sliding latch plate will face the front of the vehicle.  
2. Unlatch the center safety belt by pressing the red  
button on the buckle.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Detach the center safety belt from the mini buckle  
by inserting the key into the slot in the mini buckle,  
pressing the release button, and allowing it to  
retract.  
4. Pull up the release knob, located on the top of  
the seatbacks, and fold the seatbacks forward  
and down.  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with the safety belts  
still fastened may cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the safety belts and  
return them to their normal stowed position before  
folding a rear seat.  
5. Move the safety belt buckles and safety belt in the  
center seating position out of the space between  
the seatbacks and the seat cushion so they are not  
in the way as the seat is being folded.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Firmly pull the release handles on the rear side of  
the seat cushion to unlock the seat cushion.  
8. Clip the hook to the front seat head restraint to  
keep the rear seat secure.  
7. Lift the seat cushion up and flip it forward.  
Unfolding the Seats  
To return the rear seats to the normal seating position:  
1. Unclip the hook from the front seat head restraint.  
2. Position the buckles in back of the seat latches  
when moving the rear seats to the sitting position.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Damage to the safety belt buckle or rear  
seat locking mechanism can occur if the safety  
belt and buckles are pinched under the rear seat  
cushion. Do not place the safety belt and buckles  
on the floor under the rear seat cushion when the  
rear seat is put back to the sitting position.  
WARNING:  
{
A safety belt that is improperly routed, not  
properly attached, or twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The person wearing  
the belt could be seriously injured. After raising  
the rear seatback, always check to be sure that  
the safety belts are properly routed and attached,  
and are not twisted.  
3. Push the seat cushion down to its original position  
until it latches securely. Try to pull up on the seat  
to make sure it is locked in place.  
5. Lift the seatbacks up and push them back to their  
original latched positions.  
6. Unhook the safety belts in the outboard seating  
positions from the retaining clips.  
4. Hook the safety belts in the outboard seating  
positions into the retaining clips.  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Return the safety belt buckles and the center seat  
safety belt to their original position between the  
rear seatback and the seat cushion. Make sure  
the straps of the safety belt and buckles are not  
twisted.  
Safety Belts  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone  
This section of the manual describes how to use safety  
belts properly. It also describes some things not to do  
with safety belts.  
8. To reattach the center seat safety belt to the mini  
buckle, pull it from the retractor.  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
Do not let anyone ride where a safety belt  
cannot be worn properly. In a crash, if you or  
your passenger(s) are not wearing safety belts,  
the injuries can be much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be ejected from  
the vehicle. You and your passenger(s) can be  
seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, you  
might not be, if you are buckled up. Always fasten  
your safety belt, and check that your passenger(s)  
are restrained properly too.  
9. Push down and rearward firmly on the top of the  
seatbacks until they latch securely in the fully  
upright position.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles,  
the facts are clear. In most crashes buckling up does  
matter ... a lot!  
WARNING:  
{
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as  
it goes.  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo  
area, inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to  
be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people  
to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not  
equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure  
everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a  
safety belt properly.  
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the  
safety belts. See Safety Belt Reminders on page 424  
for additional information.  
In most states and in all Canadian provinces, the law  
requires wearing safety belts. Here is why:  
You never know if you will be in a crash. If you do have  
a crash, you do not know if it will be a serious one.  
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be  
so serious that even buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are in between. In many of  
them, people who buckle up can survive and sometimes  
walk away. Without safety belts, they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose it is just a seat on  
wheels.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Put someone on it.  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the vehicle. The rider  
does not stop.  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The person keeps going until stopped by something. In  
a real vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
or the instrument panel...  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Questions and Answers About Safety  
Belts  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I  
am wearing a safety belt?  
A: You could be whether you are wearing a safety  
belt or not. But your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so you can unbuckle  
and get out, is much greater if you are belted. And  
you can unbuckle a safety belt, even if you are  
upside down.  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to  
wear safety belts?  
A: Airbags are supplemental systems only; so they  
work with safety belts not instead of them.  
Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants  
still have to buckle up to get the most protection.  
That is true not only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other collisions.  
or the safety belts!  
With safety belts, you slow down as the vehicle does.  
You get more time to stop. You stop over more distance,  
and your strongest bones take the forces. That is why  
safety belts make such good sense.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I never drive far from  
home, why should I wear safety belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly  
This section is only for people of adult size.  
A: You may be an excellent driver, but if you are in a  
crash even one that is not your fault you and  
your passenger(s) can be hurt. Being a good driver  
does not protect you from things beyond your  
control, such as bad drivers.  
Be aware that there are special things to know about  
safety belts and children. And there are different rules  
for smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in  
the vehicle, see Older Children on page 232 or Infants  
and Young Children on page 235. Follow those rules  
for everyone's protection.  
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of  
home. And the greatest number of serious injuries  
and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph  
(65 km/h).  
It is very important for all occupants to buckle up.  
Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts.  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Occupants who are not buckled up can be thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others in the  
vehicle who are wearing safety belts.  
First, before you or your passenger(s) wear a safety  
belt, there is important information you should know.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In a crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones  
and you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt.  
If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your  
abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or  
crash.  
Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor  
in front of you. The lap part of the belt should be worn  
low and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is  
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward too  
much, which could increase injury. The shoulder  
belt should fit snugly against your body.  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose. It will not give as  
much protection this way.  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too  
loose. In a crash, you could slide under the lap  
belt and apply force on your abdomen. This could  
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The lap belt  
should be worn low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs.  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will not give nearly as  
much protection this way.  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled  
in the wrong place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen. The belt forces  
would be there, not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal injuries. Always  
buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you.  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong buckle.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over  
an armrest like this. The belt would be much too  
high. In a crash, you can slide under the belt. The  
belt force would then be applied on the abdomen,  
not on the pelvic bones, and that could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. Be sure the belt goes  
under the armrests.  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if you wear the  
shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash, your  
body would move too far forward, which would  
increase the chance of head and neck injury.  
Also, the belt would apply too much force to the  
ribs, which are not as strong as shoulder bones.  
You could also severely injure internal organs like  
your liver or spleen. The shoulder belt should go  
over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should  
be worn over the shoulder at all times.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by not wearing the  
lap-shoulder belt properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder belt. Your body  
could move too far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt. In a  
crash, you would not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt is twisted, make  
it straight so it can work properly, or ask your  
dealer/retailer to fix it.  
A: The belt is twisted across the body.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle have a  
lap-shoulder belt.  
If you are using a rear seating position with a  
detachable safety belt and the safety belt is not  
attached, see Rear Seat Operation (Sedan) on  
page 28 or Rear Seat Operation (Hatchback) on  
page 210 for instruction on reconnecting the safety  
belt to the mini-buckle.  
The following instructions explain how to wear a  
lap-shoulder belt properly.  
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you  
can sit up straight. To see how, see Seatsin the  
Index.  
3. If the belt stops before it reaches the buckle, tilt the  
latch plate and keep pulling until it can be buckled.  
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.  
Do not let it get twisted.  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt  
across you very quickly. If this happens, let the  
belt go back slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt  
across you more slowly.  
If the shoulder portion of a passenger belt is pulled  
out all the way, the child restraint locking feature  
may be engaged. If this happens, let the belt go  
back all the way and start again.  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster,  
move it to the height that is right for you. See  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjustmentlater in this  
section for instructions on use and important safety  
information.  
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
If the latch plate will not go fully into the buckle,  
check if the correct buckle is being used.  
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure.  
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt  
6. To make the lap part tight, pull up on the  
shoulder belt.  
Extender on page 232  
.
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
It may be necessary to pull stitching on the safety  
belt through the latch plate to fully tighten the lap  
belt on smaller occupants.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height adjuster for the  
driver and right front passenger seating positions.  
Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the belt  
is centered on the shoulder. The belt should be away  
from the face and neck, but not falling off the shoulder.  
Improper shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce  
the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash.  
To move it down, press  
the release button (A) and  
move the height adjuster  
to the desired position.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle. The  
belt should return to its stowed position.  
Before a door is closed, be sure the belt is out of the  
way. If a door is slammed against a safety belt, damage  
can occur to both the safety belt and the vehicle.  
After the adjuster is set to the desired position, try to  
move it down without pressing the release button to  
make sure it has locked into position.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy  
This vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for front  
outboard occupants. Although the safety belt  
pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the  
safety belt assembly. They can help tighten the safety  
belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe  
frontal or near frontal crash if the threshold conditions  
for pretensioner activation are met.  
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant  
women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be  
seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners  
activate in a crash, they will need to be replaced, and  
probably other new parts for the vehicle's safety belt  
system. See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash on page 273.  
A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt,  
and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible,  
below the rounding, throughout the pregnancy.  
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the  
mother. When a safety belt is worn properly, it is more  
likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For  
pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making  
safety belts effective is wearing them properly.  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belt Extender  
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten around you, you  
should use it.  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
But if a safety belt is not long enough, your dealer/  
retailer will order you an extender. When you go in to  
order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the  
extender will be long enough for you. To help avoid  
personal injury, do not let someone else use it, and use  
it only for the seat it is made to fit. The extender has  
been designed for adults. Never use it for securing child  
seats. To wear it, attach it to the regular safety belt. For  
more information, see the instruction sheet that comes  
with the extender.  
Older children who have outgrown booster seats should  
wear the vehicle's safety belts.  
The manufacturer's instructions that come with the  
booster seat, state the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt  
until the child passes the below fit test:  
.
Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees  
bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the shoulder  
belt rest on the shoulder? If yes, continue. If no,  
then return to the booster seat.  
WARNING:  
{
Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips,  
touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return  
to the booster seat.  
Never do this.  
Never allow two children to wear the same safety  
belt. The safety belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two children can be  
crushed together and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one person at a time.  
Can proper safety belt fit be maintained for the  
length of the trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to  
the booster seat.  
Q: What is the proper way to wear safety belts?  
A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder belt and  
get the additional restraint a shoulder belt can  
provide. The shoulder belt should not cross the face  
or neck. The lap belt should fit snugly below the  
hips, just touching the top of the thighs. This applies  
belt force to the child's pelvic bones in a crash.  
It should never be worn over the abdomen, which  
could cause severe or even fatal internal injuries in  
a crash.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in the rear seating  
positions than in the front seating positions.  
In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike  
other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out  
of the vehicle. Older children need to use safety belts  
properly.  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow a child to wear the safety belt with the  
shoulder belt behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder  
belt properly. In a crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt. The child could  
move too far forward increasing the chance of  
head and neck injury. The child might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infants and Young Children  
WARNING:  
{
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes  
infants and all other children. Neither the distance  
traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes  
the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact,  
the law in every state in the United States and in every  
Canadian province says children up to some age must  
be restrained while in a vehicle.  
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Never leave  
children unattended in a vehicle and never allow  
children to play with the safety belts.  
Airbags plus lapshoulder belts offer protection for  
adults and older children, but not for young children and  
infants. Neither the vehicle's safety belt system nor its  
airbag system is designed for them. Every time infants  
and young children ride in vehicles, they should have  
the protection provided by appropriate child restraints.  
Children who are not restrained properly can strike  
other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a  
vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it  
during a crash. For example, in a crash at only  
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will  
suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a  
person's arms. An infant should be secured in an  
appropriate restraint.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in  
the right front seat. Secure a rear-facing child  
restraint in a rear seat. It is also better to secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in a rear seat. If you  
must secure a forward-facing child restraint in the  
right front seat, always move the front passenger  
seat as far back as it will go.  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What are the different types of add-on child  
restraints?  
WARNING:  
{
A: Add-on child restraints, which are purchased by the  
vehicle's owner, are available in four basic types.  
Selection of a particular restraint should take into  
consideration not only the child's weight, height,  
and age but also whether or not the restraint will be  
compatible with the motor vehicle in which it will  
be used.  
To reduce the risk of neck and head injury during  
a crash, infants need complete support. This is  
because an infant's neck is not fully developed  
and its head weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a  
rear-facing child restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be distributed across the  
strongest part of an infant's body, the back and  
shoulders. Infants should always be secured in  
rear-facing child restraints.  
For most basic types of child restraints, there are  
many different models available. When purchasing a  
child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a  
motor vehicle. If it is, the restraint will have a label  
saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety  
standards.  
The restraint manufacturer's instructions that  
come with the restraint state the weight and height  
limitations for a particular child restraint. In addition,  
there are many kinds of restraints available for  
children with special needs.  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Restraint Systems  
WARNING:  
{
A rear-facing infant  
seat (A) provides restraint  
with the seating surface  
against the back of the  
infant.  
A young child's hip bones are still so small that  
the vehicle's regular safety belt may not remain  
low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may  
settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a body area that is  
unprotected by any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce  
the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash,  
young children should always be secured in  
appropriate child restraints.  
The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a  
crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint.  
A forward-facing child  
seat (B) provides restraint  
for the child's body with  
the harness.  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing an Add-On Child Restraint in  
the Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child restraint is not properly secured in the  
vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the  
vehicle using the vehicle's safety belt or LATCH  
system, following the instructions that came with  
that child restraint and the instructions in this  
manual.  
A booster seat (C-D) is a child restraint designed to  
improve the fit of the vehicle's safety belt system.  
A booster seat can also help a child to see out the  
window.  
To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint  
must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraint  
systems must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts  
or the lap belt portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the  
LATCH system. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH) on page 244 for more information.  
A child can be endangered in a crash if the child  
restraint is not properly secured in the vehicle.  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When securing an add-on child restraint, refer to the  
instructions that come with the restraint which may be  
on the restraint itself or in a booklet, or both, and to this  
manual. The child restraint instructions are important,  
so if they are not available, obtain a replacement copy  
from the manufacturer.  
Securing the Child Within the Child  
Restraint  
WARNING:  
{
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child is  
in it.  
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child is not properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child properly following the  
instructions that came with that child restraint.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where to Put the Restraint  
Accident statistics show that children are safer if they  
are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is turned off.  
We recommend that children and child restraints be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint; a child riding in a  
forward-facing child seat; an older child riding in a  
booster seat; and children, who are large enough, using  
safety belts.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
A label on your sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING:  
{
See Passenger Sensing System on page 265  
for additional information.  
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with your  
child restraint to make sure it is compatible with this  
vehicle.  
(Continued)  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There are a couple of things you need to know about  
using child restraints in your rear seat:  
Therefore, you will not be able to secure a child  
restraint or have a passenger ride in the center rear  
seating position.  
If you use a child  
restraint in the center  
rear seating position (A),  
the safety belts and the  
child restraint LATCH  
anchors for the rear  
outside seating  
Wherever you install a child restraint, be sure to secure  
the child restraint properly.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in your vehicle even when no child is  
in it.  
positions (B) will not  
be accessible.  
Therefore, you will not be able to secure child restraints  
or have passengers ride in the rear outside seating  
positions.  
If you use two child  
restraints (A) in the  
rear outside seating  
positions, the safety belt  
for the center rear seat  
position (B) will not be  
accessible.  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lower Anchors  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH)  
The LATCH system holds a child restraint during  
driving or in a crash. This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier. The LATCH  
system uses anchors in the vehicle and attachments on  
the child restraint that are made for use with the LATCH  
system.  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible child restraint  
is properly installed using the anchors, or use the  
vehicle's safety belts to secure the restraint, following  
the instructions that came with that restraint, and also  
the instructions in this manual. When installing a child  
restraint with a top tether, you must also use either the  
lower anchors or the safety belts to properly secure the  
child restraint. A child restraint must never be installed  
using only the top tether and anchor.  
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars built into the vehicle.  
There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating  
position that will accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle, you  
need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments.  
The child restraint manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the child restraint and its  
attachments. The following explains how to attach a  
child restraint with these attachments in your vehicle.  
Not all vehicle seating positions or child restraints have  
lower anchors and attachments or top tether anchors  
and attachments.  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Some child restraints that have a top tether are  
designed for use with or without the top tether being  
attached. Others require the top tether always to  
be attached. In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and  
that the tether be attached. Be sure to read and follow  
the instructions for your child restraint.  
Top Tether Anchor  
If the child restraint does not have a top tether, one can  
be obtained, in kit form, for many child restraints. Ask  
the child restraint manufacturer whether or not a kit is  
available.  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor  
Locations  
i (Top Tether Anchor):  
Seating positions with top  
tether anchors.  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top of the child restraint  
to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the  
vehicle. The top tether attachment (B) on the child  
restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle  
in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of  
the child restraint during driving or in a crash.  
j (Lower Anchor):  
Seating positions with  
two lower anchors.  
Your child restraint may have a single tether (A) or a  
dual tether (C). Either will have a single attachment (B)  
to secure the top tether to the anchor.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To assist you in locating  
the lower anchors, each  
seating position with lower  
anchors has two labels,  
near the crease between  
the seatback and the seat  
cushion.  
Hatchback models may have zippers over the lower  
anchor areas. If so, unzip the seat cover below the  
labels to access each lower anchor.  
Sedan  
To assist you in locating  
the top tether anchors, the  
top tether anchor symbol  
is located on the cover.  
For sedan models, the top tether anchors are located  
under the covers behind the rear seat on the filler panel.  
Pull open the cover to access the top tether anchors.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on the same side of  
the vehicle as the seating position where the child  
restraint will be placed.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The cargo shade should remain off while the top tether  
is in use. Be sure to use an anchor located on the same  
side of the vehicle as the seating position where the  
child restraint will be placed.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top tether must  
be attached.  
Accident statistics show that children are safer if they  
are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat. See  
Where to Put the Restraint on page 242 for additional  
information.  
Hatchback  
For hatchback models, the top tether anchors (B) are  
located in the rear cargo area, attached to the back  
wall (A) of the vehicle. Squeeze and pull the front part  
of the plastic cover to access the top tether anchors.  
Remove the cargo shade before installing the top tether.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the  
LATCH System  
WARNING:  
{
Do not attach more than one child restraint to a  
single anchor. Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could cause the  
anchor or attachment to come loose or even  
break during a crash. A child or others could be  
injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal  
injuries during a crash, attach only one child  
restraint per anchor.  
WARNING:  
{
If a LATCH-type child restraint is not attached to  
anchors, the child restraint will not be able to  
protect the child correctly. In a crash, the child  
could be seriously injured or killed. Install a  
LATCH-type child restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle's safety belts to  
secure the restraint, following the instructions that  
came with the child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
WARNING:  
{
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Buckle any  
unused safety belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder  
belt all the way out of the retractor to set the lock,  
if your vehicle has one, after the child restraint  
has been installed.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH attachments rub  
against the vehicles safety belts. This may damage  
these parts. If necessary, move buckled safety belts  
to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments.  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that  
the top tether be attached, attach and tighten the  
top tether to the top tether anchor, if equipped.  
Refer to the child restraint instructions and the  
following steps:  
Do not fold the empty rear seat with a safety belt  
buckled. This could damage the safety belt or the  
seat. Unbuckle and return the safety belt to its  
stowed position, before folding the seat.  
2.1. Find the top tether anchor.  
2.2. Flip the cover to access the top tether  
anchors.  
1. Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the  
lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have  
lower attachments or the desired seating position  
does not have lower anchors, secure the child  
restraint with the top tether and the safety belts.  
Refer to your child restraint manufacturer  
2.3. For hatchback models, remove the cargo  
shade before installing the top tether. The  
cargo shade should remain off while the top  
tether is in use.  
2.4. Raise the headrest or head restraint if the  
desired seating position has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint. See Head  
Restraints on page 22.  
instructions and the instructions in this manual.  
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired  
seating position.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on  
the child restraint to the lower anchors.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.5. Route and tighten the top tether according  
to your child restraint instructions and the  
following instructions:  
If the position you are  
using has a headrest or  
head restraint and you  
are using a dual tether,  
route the tether under  
the headrest or head  
restraint and in between  
the headrest or head  
restraint posts.  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, route the  
tether over the seatback.  
If the position you are  
using has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, route the  
tether under the headrest  
or head restraint and in  
between the headrest or  
head restraint posts.  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a dual  
tether, route the tether  
over the seatback.  
3. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  
Seat Position  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with your child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
If your child restraint does not have the LATCH  
system, you will be using the safety belt to secure  
the child restraint in this position. Be sure to follow  
the instructions that came with the child restraint.  
Secure the child in the child restraint when and as  
the instructions say.  
If your child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 244 for how to install your child restraint using  
LATCH. If you secure a child restraint using a safety  
belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 244 for top  
tether anchor locations.  
If you need to install more than one child restraint in the  
rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the Restraint on  
page 242  
.
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top strap must  
be anchored.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
4. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
If you find that the latch plate will not go fully into  
the buckle, see if you are using the correct buckle.  
Make sure the release button is positioned so you  
would be able to unbuckle the safety belt quickly if  
necessary.  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. If your child restraint has a top tether, follow the  
child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding  
the use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 244.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicles  
safety belt and let it go back all the way. If the top tether  
is attached to a top tether anchor, disconnect it.  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Right Front Seat Position  
This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to  
secure a forward-facing child restraint. See Where to  
Put the Restraint on page 242.  
5. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. If you are  
using a forward-facing child restraint, you may find  
it helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing system  
which is designed to turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact airbag  
(if equipped) under certain conditions. See Passenger  
Sensing System on page 265 and Passenger Airbag  
Status Indicator on page 426 for more information on  
this, including important safety information.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 265  
for additional information.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 244 for how to install your child restraint using  
LATCH. If a child restraint is secured using a safety  
belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 244 for top  
tether anchor locations.  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though it is turned off.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
(Continued)  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
You will be using the lap-shoulder belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it will go before  
securing the forward-facing child restraint.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped),  
the off indicator on the passenger airbag status  
indicator should light and stay lit when you start the  
vehicle. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on  
page 426  
.
Tilt the latch plate to adjust the belt if needed.  
2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
5. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the airbag or airbags are off, the off indicator in the  
passenger airbag status indicator will come on and stay  
on when the vehicle is started.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the off symbol  
is not lit, see If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraintunder Passenger Sensing System on  
page 265 for more information.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle's  
safety belt and let it go back all the way.  
6. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. If you are  
using a forward-facing child restraint, you may find  
it helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are the most important things to know about the  
airbag system:  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following airbags:  
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
WARNING:  
{
.
A frontal airbag for the right front passenger.  
The vehicle may have the following airbags:  
You can be severely injured or killed in a crash  
if you are not wearing your safety belt even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are designed to work  
with safety belts, but do not replace them. Also,  
airbags are not designed to deploy in every  
crash. In some crashes safety belts are your  
only restraint. See When Should an Airbag  
Inflate? on page 262.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the driver.  
.
A seat-mounted side impact airbag for the right  
front passenger.  
All of the airbags in your vehicle will have the word  
AIRBAG embossed in the trim or on an attached label  
near the deployment opening.  
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear on the  
middle part of the steering wheel for the driver and on  
the instrument panel for the right front passenger.  
Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps  
reduce your chance of hitting things inside the  
vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are  
supplemental restraintsto the safety belts.  
Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety  
belt properly whether or not there is an airbag  
for that person.  
With seat-mounted side impact airbags, the word  
AIRBAG will appear on the side of the seatback closest  
to the door.  
Airbags are designed to supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Even though today's airbags  
are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from  
the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very  
quickly to do their job.  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
Airbags inflate with great force, faster than the  
blink of an eye. Anyone who is up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be  
seriously injured or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would be if you were  
sitting on the edge of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in position before and  
during a crash. Always wear your safety belt,  
even with airbags. The driver should sit as far  
back as possible while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
offer protection for adults and older children, but  
not for young children and infants. Neither the  
vehicle's safety belt system nor its airbag system  
is designed for them. Young children and infants  
need the protection that a child restraint system  
can provide. Always secure children properly in  
your vehicle. To read how, see Older Children on  
page 232 or Infants and Young Children on  
page 235  
.
There is an airbag  
Occupants should not lean on or sleep against  
the door or side windows in seating positions with  
seat-mounted airbags.  
readiness light on the  
instrument panel, which  
shows the airbag symbol.  
WARNING:  
{
The system checks the airbag electrical system for  
malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical  
problem. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 425 for  
more information.  
Children who are up against, or very close to,  
any airbag when it inflates can be seriously  
injured or killed. Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts  
(Continued)  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger's frontal airbag is in the  
instrument panel on the passenger's side.  
The driver's frontal airbag is in the middle of the  
steering wheel.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
If something is between an occupant and an  
airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it  
might force the object into that person causing  
severe injury or even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put  
anything between an occupant and an airbag,  
and do not attach or put anything on the steering  
wheel hub or on or near any other airbag  
covering.  
Do not use seat accessories that block the  
inflation path of a seat-mounted side impact  
airbag.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar  
If your vehicle has seat-mounted side impact airbags for  
the driver and right front passenger, they are in the side  
of the seatbacks closest to the door.  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
If the vehicle hits a narrow object (like a pole), the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide object (like a wall).  
When Should an Airbag Inflate?  
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to  
severe frontal or near-frontal crashes to help reduce  
the potential for severe injuries mainly to the driver's or  
right front passenger's head and chest. However, they  
are only designed to inflate if the impact exceeds a  
predetermined deployment threshold. Deployment  
thresholds are used to predict how severe a crash is  
likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help  
restrain the occupants.  
If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight into the object.  
Thresholds can also vary with specific vehicle design.  
In addition, your vehicle has dual-stage frontal airbags.  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the restraint according to  
crash severity. Your vehicle has electronic frontal  
sensors, which help the sensing system distinguish  
between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe  
frontal impact. For moderate frontal impacts, dual-stage  
airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment. For  
more severe frontal impacts, full deployment occurs.  
Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not  
based on how fast your vehicle is traveling. It depends  
largely on what you hit, the direction of the impact, and  
how quickly your vehicle slows down.  
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds.  
For example:  
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle  
rollovers, rear impacts, or in many side impacts.  
.
If the vehicle hits a stationary object, the airbags  
The vehicle may or may not have seat-mounted side  
could inflate at a different crash speed than if the  
vehicle hits a moving object.  
impact airbags. See Airbag System on page 258  
Seat-mounted side impact airbags are intended  
to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes.  
Seat-mounted side impact airbags will inflate if the  
crash severity is above the system's designed threshold  
level. The threshold level can vary with specific vehicle  
design.  
.
.
If the vehicle hits an object that deforms, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits an object that does not  
deform.  
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat-mounted side impact airbags are not intended to  
inflate in frontal impacts, near-frontal impacts, rollovers,  
or rear impacts. A seat-mounted side impact airbag is  
intended to deploy on the side of the vehicle that is  
struck.  
How Does an Airbag Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions,  
even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel  
or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side  
collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside  
of the vehicle.  
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an  
airbag should have inflated simply because of the  
damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair  
costs were. For frontal airbags, inflation is determined  
by what the vehicle hits, the angle of the impact, and  
how quickly the vehicle slows down. For seat-mounted  
side impact airbags, deployment is determined by the  
location and severity of the side impact.  
Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety  
belts. Frontal airbags distribute the force of the impact  
more evenly over the occupant's upper body, stopping  
the occupant more gradually. Seat-mounted side impact  
airbags distribute the force of the impact more evenly  
over the occupant's upper body.  
But airbags would not help in many types of collisions,  
primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward  
those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 262 for more information.  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?  
In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an  
electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the  
bag to break out of the cover and deploy. The inflator,  
the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the  
airbag module.  
Airbags should never be regarded as anything more  
than a supplement to safety belts.  
Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering  
wheel and instrument panel. For vehicles with  
seat-mounted side impact airbags, there are airbag  
modules in the side of the front seatbacks closest to  
the door.  
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What Will You See After an Airbag  
Inflates?  
WARNING: (Continued)  
After the frontal and seat-mounted side impact airbags  
inflate, they quickly deflate, so quickly that some  
people may not even realize the airbags inflated.  
Some components of the airbag module may be hot  
for several minutes. For location of the airbag modules,  
see What Makes an Airbag Inflate? on page 263.  
fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you  
experience breathing problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek medical attention.  
The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock  
the doors, turn the interior lamps on, turn on the hazard  
warning flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the  
airbags inflate. You can lock the doors, turn the interior  
lamps off, and turn the hazard warning flashers off by  
using the controls for those features.  
The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you  
may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be  
some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the  
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the  
driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to  
steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from  
leaving the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags may  
have also damaged important functions in the  
vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and  
steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears  
to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may  
be concealed damage that could make it difficult  
to safely operate the vehicle.  
When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in  
the air. This dust could cause breathing problems  
for people with a history of asthma or other  
breathing trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the  
vehicle should get out as soon as it is safe to do  
so. If you have breathing problems but cannot get  
out of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get  
Use caution if you should attempt to restart the  
engine after a crash has occurred.  
(Continued)  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag,  
windshields are broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may also occur from the  
right front passenger airbag.  
Passenger Sensing System  
The vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the  
right front passenger position. The passenger airbag  
status indicator will be visible, near the clock, located in  
the center of the instrument panel, when the vehicle is  
started.  
.
Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an  
airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for  
the airbag system. If you do not get them, the  
airbag system will not be there to help protect you  
in another crash. A new system will include airbag  
modules and possibly other parts. The service  
manual for your vehicle covers the need to replace  
other parts.  
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic  
module which records information after a crash.  
See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy on  
page 818 and Event Data Recorders on  
United States  
Canada  
page 818  
.
The words PASSENGER AIRBAG ON and  
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF or the symbols for  
on and off will be visible, during the system check.  
.
Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag  
system. Improper service can mean that the  
airbag system will not work properly. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
When the system check is complete, either the words  
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON and PASSENGER AIRBAG  
OFF or the symbol for on and off will be visible. See  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 426  
.
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side  
impact airbag (if equipped) under certain conditions.  
The driver airbags are not affected by the passenger  
sensing system.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
The passenger sensing system works with sensors  
that are part of the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the presence of a  
properly-seated occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side  
impact airbag (if equipped) should be enabled (may  
inflate) or not.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer  
when properly secured in a rear seat in the correct  
child restrain for their weight and size.  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped),  
no system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the airbag(s) are off.  
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat,  
including: an infant or a child riding in a rear-facing child  
restraint; a child riding in a forward-facing child seat; an  
older child riding in a booster seat; and children, who  
are large enough, using safety belts.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag(s) are off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped) if:  
For some children who have outgrown child restraints  
and for very small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact airbag  
(if equipped), depending upon the person's seating  
posture and body build. Everyone in your vehicle who  
has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is an airbag for that  
person.  
.
The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.  
.
The system determines that an infant is present in  
a child restraint.  
.
A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of  
the seat for a period of time.  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag  
system or the passenger sensing system.  
WARNING:  
{
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted  
side impact airbag (if equipped), the off indicator will  
light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag or airbags  
are off. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on  
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 425  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
page 426  
.
The passenger sensing system is designed to enable  
(may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped) anytime  
the system senses that a person of adult size is sitting  
properly in the right front passenger seat. When the  
passenger sensing system has allowed the airbag or  
airbags to be enabled, the on symbol will light and stay  
lit to remind you that the airbag or airbags are active.  
2-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting  
the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the  
vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint  
seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable,  
to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not  
pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped  
under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens,  
adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on  
2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.  
3. Remove any additional items from the seat such  
as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,  
or seat massagers.  
page 22  
.
6. Restart the vehicle.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions  
provided by the child restraint manufacturer and  
refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position on page 253.  
If the on indicator is still lit, secure the child in the child  
restraint in a rear seat position in the vehicle, and check  
with your dealer/retailer.  
2-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and enable the right front  
passenger frontal airbag and seat-mounted side impact  
airbag (if equipped):  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
AdultSize Occupant  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material from the seat,  
such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered  
on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in  
this position for two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in the right front  
passenger seat, but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting properly in the seat.  
2-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional Factors Affecting System  
Operation  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle  
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on  
the seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which  
helps the passenger sensing system maintain the  
passenger airbag status. See Safety Beltsand Child  
Restraintsin the Index for additional information about  
the importance of proper restraint use.  
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced.  
There are parts of the airbag system in several places  
around the vehicle. Your dealer/retailer and the service  
manual have information about servicing the vehicle  
and the airbag system. To purchase a service manual,  
see Service Publications Ordering Information on  
page 817  
.
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket  
or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect  
how well the passenger sensing system operates.  
We recommend that you not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment other than any that GM has  
approved for your specific vehicle. See Adding  
Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
page 271 for more information about modifications  
that can affect how the system operates.  
WARNING:  
{
For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off  
and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still  
inflate during improper service. You can be injured  
if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid  
yellow connectors. They are probably part of the  
airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service  
procedures, and make sure the person performing  
work for you is qualified to do so.  
WARNING:  
{
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat  
or between the passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the proper operation  
of the passenger sensing system.  
2-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
sensing system. This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent  
the passenger sensing system from properly turning  
off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing  
System on page 265.  
Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
Q: Is there anything I might add to or change about  
the vehicle that could keep the airbags from  
working properly?  
If you have any questions about this, you should  
contact Customer Assistance before you modify  
your vehicle. The phone numbers and addresses  
for Customer Assistance are in Step Two of the  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure in this manual.  
See Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
A: Yes. If you add things that change your vehicle's  
frame, bumper system, height, front end or side  
sheet metal, they may keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or moving any parts  
of the front seats, safety belts, the airbag sensing  
and diagnostic module, steering wheel, instrument  
panel, front sensors, or airbag wiring can affect the  
operation of the airbag system.  
Q: Because I have a disability, I have to get my  
vehicle modified. How can I find out whether this  
will affect my airbag system?  
In addition, the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, which  
includes sensors that are part of the passenger seat.  
The passenger sensing system may not operate  
properly if the original seat trim is replaced with  
non-GM covers, upholstery or trim, or with GM  
covers, upholstery or trim designed for a different  
vehicle. Any object, such as an aftermarket seat  
heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device,  
installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could  
also interfere with the operation of the passenger  
A: If you have questions, call Customer Assistance.  
The phone numbers and addresses for Customer  
Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
In addition, your dealer/retailer and the service manual  
have information about the location of the airbag  
sensors, sensing and diagnostic module and airbag  
wiring.  
2-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags  
Restraint System Check  
The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled  
maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag  
readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light  
on page 425 for more information.  
Checking the Restraint Systems  
Safety Belts  
Notice: If an airbag covering is damaged, opened,  
or broken, the airbag may not work properly.  
Do not open or break the airbag coverings. If there  
are any opened or broken airbag covers, have the  
airbag covering and/or airbag module replaced.  
For the location of the airbag modules, see What  
Makes an Airbag Inflate? on page 263. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
Now and then, check that the safety belt reminder  
light, safety belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors,  
and anchorages are all working properly.  
Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system  
parts that might keep a safety belt system from doing its  
job. See your dealer/retailer to have it repaired. Torn or  
frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash. They  
can rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or  
frayed, get a new one right away.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder light is working.  
See Safety Belt Reminders on page 424 for more  
information.  
Keep safety belts clean and dry. See Care of Safety  
Belts on page 682  
.
2-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being  
used during a crash, you may need new LATCH system  
parts.  
Replacing Restraint System Parts  
After a Crash  
New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the  
safety belt or LATCH system (if equipped), was not  
being used at the time of the crash.  
WARNING:  
{
If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag  
system parts. See the part on the airbag system earlier  
in this section.  
A crash can damage the restraint systems in your  
vehicle. A damaged restraint system may not  
properly protect the person using it, resulting in  
serious injury or even death in a crash. To help  
make sure your restraint systems are working  
properly after a crash, have them inspected and  
any necessary replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners checked if the  
vehicle has been in a crash, if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after the vehicle is started, or while you are  
driving. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 425  
.
If the vehicle has been in a crash, do you need new  
safety belts or LATCH system (if equipped) parts?  
After a very minor crash, nothing may be necessary.  
But the safety belt assemblies that were used during  
any crash may have been stressed or damaged. See  
your dealer/retailer to have the safety belt assemblies  
inspected or replaced.  
2-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
2-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Automatic Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Manual Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) . . . 3-28  
Shifting Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Parking the Vehicle (Manual Transmission) . . . . 3-31  
Parking Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Door Ajar Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Liftgate (Hatchback) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Outside Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Outside Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Immobilizer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key  
is dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function with the keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the  
path of a closing window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The key can be used for the ignition, doors and all other  
locks.  
The key has a key code tag that the dealer/retailer or  
qualified locksmith can use to make new keys. Store  
this information in a safe place, not in your vehicle.  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Your vehicle may have an electronic immobilizer  
designed to protect your car against theft. If so, only  
keys with the correct electronic code can be used  
to start the vehicle. See Immobilizer Operation on  
page 314 for additional information. If a replacement  
key or an additional key is needed, it must be  
purchased from your dealer/retailer or certified  
locksmith.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Changes or modifications to this system by other than  
an authorized service facility could void authorization to  
use this equipment.  
Notice: If you ever lock your keys in the vehicle,  
you may have to damage the vehicle to get in.  
Be sure you have spare keys.  
If there is a decrease in the RKE operating range,  
try this:  
.
In an emergency, contact Roadside Assistance.  
See Roadside Assistance Program on page 87 for  
more information.  
Check the distance. The transmitter may be too  
far from the vehicle. Stand closer during rainy or  
snowy weather.  
.
Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may  
be blocking the signal. Take a few steps to the left  
or right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.  
.
Check the transmitter's battery. See Battery  
Replacementlater in this section.  
.
If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see  
your dealer/retailer or a qualified technician for  
service.  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter functions  
work up to 65 feet (20 m) away from the vehicle.  
The following functions may be available if the vehicle  
has RKE:  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all of the doors. If all of the  
doors and the trunk or liftgate are closed, the hazard  
lamps flash once and the horn will sound to indicate  
that locking has occurred and the theft-deterrent system  
is active.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 33.  
K (Unlock): Press to unlock all of the doors. The  
hazard lamps flash twice to indicate that unlocking  
has occurred and that the theft-deterrent system is  
deactivated. If the doors are not opened within  
30 seconds the doors will lock again.  
3 (Panic) (Hatchback): Press to sound the panic  
alarm. The hazard lamps will flash and the panic alarm  
will stay on for about 30 seconds. Press any of the  
buttons on the transmitter to turn off the alarm.  
V (Remote Trunk Release) (Sedan): Press and hold  
for approximately one second to open the trunk.  
The LED light (A) on the transmitter flashes when the  
buttons on the transmitter are pressed. If the light does  
not flash see Battery Replacementlater in this section.  
Hatchback  
Sedan  
The buttons do not operate and the theft-deterrent  
system does not activate if the key is in the ignition.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To replace the battery:  
Programming Transmitters to the  
Vehicle  
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will  
work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement  
can be purchased and programmed through your  
dealer/retailer. When the replacement transmitter  
is programmed to the vehicle, all remaining  
1. Remove the screw from the back of the cover and  
open the cover of the transmitter.  
2. Pull the transmitter out of the cover and carefully  
turn the circle cover of the transmitter unit  
toward open.  
3. Remove the battery.  
transmitters must also be programmed. Any lost  
or stolen transmitters no longer work once the new  
transmitter is programmed. Each vehicle can have  
up to five transmitters programmed to it.  
4. Insert the new battery, positive side facing up. Use  
one three-volt, CR1620, or equivalent, type battery.  
5. Turn the circle cover of the transmitter unit toward  
close and put the transmitter unit in the cover.  
Battery Replacement  
Replace the battery if the LED on the transmitter does  
not flash when you press the buttons.  
6. Put the two halves back together and replace the  
screw. Make sure the cover is on tightly, so water  
will not get in.  
7. Test the transmitter operation.  
Notice: When replacing the battery, do not touch  
any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from  
your body could damage the transmitter.  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Doors and Locks  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Door Locks  
.
Outsiders can easily enter through an  
unlocked door when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your doors can help  
prevent this from happening.  
WARNING:  
{
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.  
.
There are several ways to lock and unlock the vehicle.  
Passengers, especially children, can easily  
open the doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. When a door is locked, the handle  
will not open it. The chance of being thrown  
out of the vehicle in a crash is increased if  
the doors are not locked. So, all passengers  
should wear safety belts properly and the  
doors should be locked whenever the vehicle  
is driven.  
From the outside, use your key or the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter. See Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation on page 34.  
To manually unlock the front doors from the outside,  
insert the key and turn it counterclockwise. To manually  
lock the doors, insert the key and turn it clockwise.  
All doors, except for the driver door, can be locked by  
pushing down the manual door lock and then closing  
the door. On vehicles with power locks, the driver door  
can only by locked from the outside by using the key or  
the optional RKE transmitter.  
.
Young children who get into unlocked vehicles  
may be unable to get out. A child can be  
overcome by extreme heat and can suffer  
permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever  
leaving it.  
From the inside, all of the doors can be locked and  
unlocked by pushing or pulling the manual door lock  
located on each door.  
(Continued)  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Central Door Unlocking System  
Rear Door Security Locks  
The vehicle may be equipped with the central door  
unlocking system. This system is activated from the  
driver door.  
The vehicle has rear door  
security locks on each  
rear door that prevents  
passengers from opening  
the rear doors from the  
inside.  
From the outside, lock or unlock all the doors by using  
either the key or the RKE transmitter, if equipped. From  
the inside, lock or unlock all the doors by using the  
driver door lock switch.  
Door Ajar Reminder  
If one of the doors, trunk,  
or liftgate is not closed  
properly while the ignition  
is on, the door ajar light  
on the instrument panel  
comes on and stays on  
until the doors are closed.  
Using the Rear Door Security Lock  
1. Move the lever up to lock.  
2. Close the door.  
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 to the other rear door lock.  
Notice: Pulling the inside door handle while the rear  
door security locks are engaged could damage your  
vehicle. Do not pull the inside door handle while the  
rear door security locks are engaged.  
The rear doors on the vehicle cannot be opened from  
the inside while this feature is in use.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Opening a Rear Door When the  
Security Lock is On  
Trunk  
1. Unlock the door from the inside.  
WARNING:  
{
2. Open the door from the outside.  
If you do not cancel the security lock, adults or older  
children who ride in the rear will not be able to open the  
rear door from the inside.  
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven  
with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any  
objects that pass through the seal between the  
body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Canceling the Rear Door Security Lock  
1. Unlock the door from the inside and open the door  
from the outside.  
2. Move the lever down to unlock.  
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate,  
or trunk/hatch open:  
3. Repeat Steps 1 and 2 to the other rear door lock.  
.
Close all of the windows.  
The rear door locks can now be locked and unlocked  
normally.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that brings in only outside air and set the fan  
speed to the highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate,  
disable the power liftgate function.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 332.  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To open the trunk on a sedan from outside of the  
vehicle, insert the key into the lock cylinder and turn the  
key clockwise or use the RKE transmitter, if equipped.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
The vehicle may have  
a trunk release lever  
located on the outboard  
side of the driver seat.  
Pull the lever to open the  
trunk.  
page 34  
.
Remote Trunk Release  
This feature allows the trunk to be opened from inside  
the vehicle. the vehicle may have either a release  
button or a release lever.  
The vehicle may have a  
release button located on  
the driver door. Press it to  
open the trunk.  
When closing the trunk, close from the center to ensure  
it fully latches.  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emergency Trunk Release Handle  
Liftgate (Hatchback)  
WARNING:  
Notice: Do not use the emergency trunk release  
handle as a tie-down or anchor point when securing  
items in the trunk as it could damage the handle.  
The emergency trunk release handle is only  
{
intended to aid a person trapped in a latched trunk,  
enabling them to open the trunk from the inside.  
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven  
with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any  
objects that pass through the seal between the  
body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate,  
or trunk/hatch open:  
.
Close all of the windows.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
(Continued)  
There is a glow-in-the-dark emergency trunk release  
handle located on the underside of the trunk lid. This  
handle will glow following exposure to light. Pull the  
release handle down to open the trunk from the inside.  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that brings in only outside air and set the fan  
speed to the highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate,  
disable the power liftgate function.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 332.  
To unlock the liftgate on a hatchback from outside of  
the vehicle, insert the key in the lock cylinder and turn  
it counterclockwise or use the RKE transmitter,  
if equipped.  
The handle is located above the right side of the license  
plate. Pull the handle toward you and raise the liftgate.  
When closing the liftgate, close from the center to  
ensure it fully latches.  
To lock the liftgate, insert the key into the lock cylinder  
and turn it clockwise or use the RKE transmitter,  
if equipped.  
The liftgate can also be locked or unlocked by the  
central door unlocking system or RKE transmitter,  
if equipped. See Central Door Unlocking System on  
page 37 and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation on page 34.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children, helpless adults, or pets in a  
vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the extreme heat and  
suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a  
pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows  
closed in warm or hot weather.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Windows  
Use the window crank to open and close each window.  
The rear windows do not open fully.  
Power Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the keys is  
dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function and they could be seriously injured or  
killed if caught in the path of a closing window.  
Do not leave keys in a vehicle with children.  
On vehicles with power windows, the switches are  
located on the driver door. In addition, each passenger  
door has a switch for its own window.  
The ignition must be turned to ON/RUN to use the  
power windows. To lower the window, press and hold  
the switch. To raise the window, lift up on the switch.  
Release the switch when the window reaches the  
desired level.  
When there are children in the rear seat use the  
window lockout button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Window Lockout  
Theft-Deterrent Systems  
Vehicle theft is big business, especially in some cities.  
This vehicle has theft-deterrent features, however, they  
do not make it impossible to steal.  
The window lockout is  
located with the driver  
power window switches.  
Immobilizer  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Press the lockout button to stop the rear passengers  
from using the rear window switches. The driver can still  
operate all the windows with the lockout on. Press the  
lockout button again to return to normal window  
operation.  
Immobilizer Operation  
The vehicle may have a passive theft-deterrent system.  
The immobilizer system prevents the vehicle from being  
started by an unauthorized person by isolating the  
power supply to the ignition system, the fuel pump and  
the fuel injectors.  
Sun Visors  
To block out glare you can swing down the sun visors.  
You can also remove them from the center mount and  
swing them to the side.  
The system is automatically armed when the key is  
removed from the ignition. You do not have to manually  
arm or disarm the system.  
Visor Vanity Mirror  
The vehicle has vanity mirrors located on the back of  
the sun visors. Swing down the sun visor to expose the  
vanity mirror.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Your vehicle has a special key that works with the  
theft-deterrent system. There is a transponder in the  
key head that is electronically coded. The correct key  
will start the vehicle. An invalid key immobilizes the  
engine. If your key is ever damaged, you may not be  
able to start your vehicle.  
If you are ever driving and the security light comes on  
and stays on, you will be able to restart the engine if  
you turn it off. The theft-deterrent system, however, is  
not working properly and must be serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. Your vehicle is not protected by the  
theft-deterrent system at this time.  
When trying to start the vehicle, if the engine does not  
start and the security light flashes or comes on, there  
may be a problem with the theft-deterrent system. Turn  
the ignition off and try again.  
In an emergency, contact Roadside Assistance.  
See Roadside Assistance Program on page 87.  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
If the engine still does not start, and the key appears to  
be undamaged, try another key. At this time, you may  
also want to check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit  
Breakers on page 687. If the engine still does not start  
with the other key, your vehicle needs service. If your  
vehicle does start, the first key may be faulty. See your  
dealer/retailer who can have a new key made.  
Your vehicle may have a content theft-deterrent system.  
The theft-deterrent system will not arm when you lock  
the doors using the key or the manual door lock. It arms  
only when you use the remote keyless entry transmitter.  
Up to 10 keys may be programmed for the vehicle.  
If you lose or damage your keys, only a dealer/retailer  
can have new keys made.  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To avoid activating the alarm by accident, do one of the  
following:  
Arming the System  
To arm the system, do the following:  
.
Unlock the driver's or passenger's front door using  
1. Close the doors, the windows, the hood, and the  
trunk or liftgate.  
the key.  
.
Press the unlock button on the remote keyless  
Make sure that the windows are closed, as the  
system can be armed even if the windows  
are open.  
entry transmitter.  
Unlocking a door any other way will activate the alarm  
when a door or the trunk or liftgate is opened.  
2. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF and remove the key  
from the ignition.  
If you do not want to arm the theft-deterrent system,  
lock the vehicle using the key or the manual door locks.  
If the key is inserted in the ignition, the transmitter  
will not arm the theft-deterrent system.  
Disarming the System  
To disarm the system, do one of the following:  
3. Lock the doors by pressing the lock button on the  
remote keyless entry transmitter.  
.
Unlock the driver's or passenger's front door using  
.
The LED light on the transmitter will flash once.  
the key.  
.
All of the doors will lock.  
.
Press the unlock button on the remote keyless  
.
entry transmitter.  
The hazard warning lamps will flash once and  
the horn will sound.  
The LED light on the transmitter will flash once.  
All of the doors will unlock.  
.
The security light will flash continuously to  
indicate that the theft-deterrent system is  
armed . The security light is located on the  
center of the instrument panel near the clock.  
The hazard warning lamps will flash twice.  
If the door is not opened or if the engine is not started  
within 30 seconds after disarming the system using the  
transmitter, all of the doors will automatically lock and  
the theft-deterrent mode will rearm.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How the System Alarm is Activated  
If a door or the trunk or liftgate is opened without using  
the key or the remote keyless entry transmitter, the horn  
will sound and the lamps will flash for up to 30 seconds.  
Starting and Operating Your  
Vehicle  
New Vehicle Break-In  
Notice: The vehicle does not need an elaborate  
break-in. But it will perform better in the long run  
if you follow these guidelines:  
How to Turn Off the System Alarm  
If the system alarm is active, it can be deactivated using  
one of the following methods:  
.
.
Press one of the buttons on the remote keyless  
entry transmitter.  
Do not drive at any one constant speed,  
fast or slow, for the first 805 km (500 miles).  
Do not make full-throttle starts. Avoid  
downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle.  
.
Unlock the driver's or passenger's front door using  
the key.  
.
Avoid making hard stops for the first 322 km  
Otherwise, the alarm will automatically stop after  
30 seconds. The system will then lock the doors and  
rearm the theft-deterrent system.  
(200 miles) or so. During this time the new  
brake linings are not yet broken in. Hard  
stops with new linings can mean premature  
wear and earlier replacement. Follow this  
breaking-in guideline every time you get new  
brake linings.  
How to Detect a Tamper Condition  
If the hazard warning lamps flash once when you press  
the lock button on the remote keyless entry transmitter,  
the theft-deterrent system alarm was activated while  
you were away.  
Following breakin, engine speed and load can be  
gradually increased.  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Using a tool to force the key to turn in the  
ignition could cause damage to the switch or break  
the key. Use the correct key, make sure it is all the  
way in, and turn it only with your hand. If the key  
cannot be turned by hand, see your dealer/retailer.  
Ignition Positions  
The ignition switch has  
four different positions.  
LOCK/OFF: This position locks the steering wheel,  
ignition, shift lever and transmission. This is the only  
position in which you can insert or remove the key.  
The steering can bind with the wheels turned off center.  
If this happens, move the steering wheel from right to  
left while turning the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this  
doesn't work, then the vehicle needs service.  
ACC/ACCESSORY: This position operates some of the  
electrical accessories, such as the radio, but not the  
climate control system.  
WARNING:  
{
ON/RUN: This position can be used to operate the  
electrical accessories, and to display some instrument  
panel cluster warning and indicator lights. The switch  
stays in this position when the engine is running.  
If you leave the key in the ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN position with the engine off, the battery could  
be drained. You may not be able to start the vehicle if  
the battery is allowed to drain for an extended period  
of time.  
On manual transmission vehicles, turning the key  
to LOCK/OFF will lock the steering column and  
result in a loss of ability to steer the vehicle. This  
could cause a collision. If you need to turn the  
engine off while the vehicle is moving, turn the  
key only to ACC/ACCESSORY. Do not push the  
key in while the vehicle is moving.  
START: This is the position that starts the engine.  
When the engine cranks, release the key. The ignition  
switch returns to ON/RUN for driving. Do not turn the  
key to START if the engine is running.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle has a ComputerControlled Cranking  
System. It assists in starting the engine and  
protects components. If the ignition key is turned  
to START and then released when the engine  
begins cranking, the engine will continue cranking  
for a few seconds or until the engine starts.  
If the engine does not start and the key is held in  
START, cranking will be stopped after 15 seconds  
to prevent damage. To prevent gear damage,  
cranking is not allowed if the engine is running.  
Engine cranking can be stopped by turning the  
ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or LOCK/OFF.  
Starting the Engine  
Automatic Transmission  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). The  
engine will not start in any other position. To restart  
the engine when the vehicle is already moving, use  
N (Neutral) only.  
Notice: Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle  
is moving. If you do, you could damage the  
transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the  
vehicle is stopped.  
Notice: Holding the key in START for longer than  
15 seconds at a time will cause the battery to be  
drained much sooner. And the excessive heat can  
damage the starter motor. Wait about 15 seconds  
between each try to help avoid draining the battery  
or damaging the starter.  
Manual Transmission  
The shift lever should be in N (Neutral) and the parking  
brake engaged. Hold the clutch pedal to the floor and  
start the engine. The vehicle will not start if the clutch  
pedal is not all the way down.  
2. If the engine does not start, wait about 15 seconds  
and try again. Wait about 15 seconds between  
each try.  
Starting Procedure  
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the  
ignition to START. When the engine cranks, let go  
of the key. The idle speed will go down as the  
engine gets warm.  
When the engine has run about 10 seconds to  
warm up, the vehicle is ready to be driven. Do not  
run the engine at high speed when it is cold.  
If the weather is below freezing (0°C or 32°F), let  
the engine run for a few minutes to warm up.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. If the engine still will not start, or starts but then  
stops, it could be flooded with too much gasoline.  
Try pushing the accelerator pedal all the way to  
the floor and holding it there as you hold the key  
in START for about three seconds. If the vehicle  
starts briefly but then stops again, do the same  
thing, but this time keep the pedal down for five or  
six seconds. This clears the extra gasoline from  
the engine.  
Vehicles with an engine heater should be plugged in at  
least four hours before starting. To assist you in finding  
the cord, the vehicle will have one of the following  
designs:  
Removable Extension Cord  
1. Turn off the engine.  
Notice: The engine is designed to work with the  
electronics in the vehicle. If electrical parts or  
accessories are added, you could change the way  
the engine operates. Before adding electrical  
equipment, check with your dealer/retailer. If you do  
not, the engine might not perform properly. Any  
resulting damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
Engine Heater  
The engine heater can provide easier starting  
and better fuel economy during engine warm-up in  
cold weather conditions at or below 18°C (0°F).  
2. Remove the extension cord from the trunk. Open  
the hood and connect the electrical cord with the  
extension cord.  
3. Plug the extension cord into a normal, grounded  
110-Volt AC outlet.  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug both  
the extension cord and under hood electrical cord,  
and store them as they were before. This will keep  
them away from moving engine parts, and prevent  
damage.  
WARNING:  
{
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet  
could cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong  
kind of extension cord could overheat and cause  
a fire. You could be seriously injured. Plug the  
cord into a properly grounded three-prong  
110-volt AC outlet. If the cord will not reach,  
use a heavy-duty three-prong extension cord  
rated for at least 15 amps.  
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in  
depends on several factors. Ask a dealer/retailer in the  
area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best  
advice on this.  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Attached Extension Cord  
1. Turn off the engine.  
WARNING:  
{
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet  
could cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong  
kind of extension cord could overheat and cause  
a fire. You could be seriously injured. Plug the  
cord into a properly grounded three-prong  
110-volt AC outlet. If the cord will not reach,  
use a heavy-duty three-prong extension cord  
rated for at least 15 amps.  
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and  
store the cord as it was before to keep it away from  
moving engine parts. If you do not it could be  
damaged.  
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in  
depends on several factors. Ask a dealer/retailer in the  
area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best  
advice on this.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord. The  
cord is located in the driver side of the engine  
compartment, near the battery.  
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-Volt AC outlet.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Operation  
WARNING:  
{
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift  
lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is  
running unless you have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly.  
You or others could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly  
level ground, always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into  
Park (Automatic Transmission) on page 328.  
Ensure that the shift lever is fully in P (Park) before  
starting the engine. The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control system. You have to  
apply the brake pedal before you can shift from P (Park)  
when the key is in ON/RUN. If you cannot shift out  
of P (Park) while holding the brake pedal down, see  
Shifting Out of Park on page 330.  
If the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the shift  
lever is located on the console between the seats.  
Movement between certain positions requires pushing  
the release button on the front of the shifter.  
P (Park): This position locks the front wheels. It is the  
best position to use when you start the engine because  
the vehicle cannot move easily.  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
R (Reverse): Use this gear to back up.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with  
the engine running at high speed may damage the  
transmission. The repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not  
running at high speed when shifting the vehicle.  
When shifting from N (Neutral) to R (Reverse), you need  
to apply the brake pedal and push the release button on  
the front of the shifter.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
D4 (Automatic Overdrive): This position is for normal  
driving.  
When operating the vehicle in severe cold conditions,  
the transmission may be prevented from shifting  
into D4 gear until the transmission fluid has warmed  
up to it's operational temperature.  
To rock the vehicle back and forth to get out of snow,  
ice or sand without damaging the transmission, see  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on  
Notice: If the vehicle seems to start up rather  
slowly or not shift gears when you go faster, and  
you continue to drive the vehicle that way, you  
could damage the transmission. Have the vehicle  
serviced right away. You can drive in 2 (Second)  
when you are driving less than 35 mph (55 km/h)  
and D4 (Automatic Overdrive) for higher speeds  
until then.  
page 514  
.
N (Neutral): In this position, the engine does not  
connect with the wheels. To restart the engine while  
the vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only.  
Also, use N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed.  
WARNING:  
{
2 (Second): This position gives you more power but  
lower fuel economy. You can use 2 (Second) on hills.  
It can help control vehicle speed as you go down steep  
mountain roads, while using the brakes off and on.  
Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is  
running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your  
foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could  
move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear  
while the engine is running at high speed.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Do not drive in 2 (Second) at speeds  
over 65 mph (105 km/h), or you can damage the  
transmission. Use D4 (Automatic Overdrive) as  
much as possible. Do not shift into 2 (Second)  
unless you are going slower than 65 mph (105 km/h)  
or you can damage the engine.  
Hold Mode  
If the vehicle's transmission has hold mode, you can  
select this mode to allow the automatic transmission to  
stay in a specific gear range.  
1 (First): This position gives you even more power but  
lower fuel economy than 2 (Second). You can use it on  
very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud. If the shift  
lever is put in 1 (First), the transmission will not shift into  
first gear until the vehicle is going slowly enough.  
Notice: Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in  
one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal  
may damage the transmission. The repair will not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are stuck, do  
not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the  
brakes to hold the vehicle in place.  
If there is a malfunction with the automatic transmission,  
the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) or the HOLD  
indicator light will turn on or flash. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 431.  
Press the HOLD button on the shift lever console to turn  
on hold mode. The HOLD light on the instrument panel  
cluster will turn on. Press the button again to turn off  
hold mode, and return to normal automatic transmission  
operation.  
Have the vehicle fixed as soon as possible.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When hold mode is activated, the transmission runs as  
follows:  
Manual Transmission Operation  
Five-Speed  
Selector Lever Position  
Gear Range  
Third Gear  
Second Gear  
First Gear  
D4  
2
1
See Hold Mode Light on page 429.  
When Hold Mode is selected in D4 (Drive), the  
transmission is held in 3 (Third) gear, which locks out  
D4 (Drive). This allows for engine braking when slowing  
from higher speeds.  
When Hold Mode is selected in 2 (Second), the  
transmission will start in 2 (Second) gear instead of  
1 (First), helping to reduce wheel spin when starting  
out on slippery surface such as snow, mud or ice.  
Since selecting Hold Mode in D4 (Drive) locks the  
transmission in 3 (Third), and prevents downshifts to  
2 (Second) or 1 (First), acceleration from a stop or near  
stop on dry pavement will be slower than expected.  
Hold Mode should not be selected during these  
situations.  
This is your shift pattern.  
1 (First): Press the clutch pedal and shift into 1 (First).  
Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press the  
accelerator pedal.  
You can shift into 1 (First) when you are going less than  
20 mph (32 km/h). If you have come to a complete stop  
and it is hard to shift into 1 (First), put the shift lever in  
N (Neutral) and let up on the clutch. Press the clutch  
pedal back down. Then shift into 1 (First).  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 (Second): Press the clutch pedal as you let up on the  
accelerator pedal and shift into 2 (Second). Then, slowly  
let up on the clutch pedal as you press the accelerator  
pedal.  
Shift Speeds  
WARNING:  
{
3 (Third), 4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth): Shift into 3 (Third),  
4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth), the same way you do for  
2 (Second). Slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you  
press the accelerator pedal.  
If you skip a gear when you downshift, you could  
lose control of the vehicle. You could injure  
yourself or others. Do not shift down more than  
one gear at a time when you downshift.  
To stop, let up on the accelerator pedal and press  
the brake pedal. Just before the vehicle stops, press  
the clutch pedal and the brake pedal, and shift to  
N (Neutral).  
UpShift Light  
N (Neutral): Use this position when you start or idle the  
engine.  
Vehicles equipped with  
a manual transmission  
may have an up-shift light.  
This light indicates when  
to shift to the next higher  
gear for better fuel  
R (Reverse): To back up, press down the clutch  
pedal, lift up the ring on the shift lever and shift into  
R (Reverse). Let up on the clutch pedal slowly while  
pressing the accelerator pedal.  
economy.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly and shift  
when the light comes on, and if the weather, road, and  
traffic conditions allow.  
Also, use R (Reverse), along with the parking brake, for  
parking the vehicle.  
It is normal for the light to go on and off if the  
accelerator position changes quickly. Ignore the  
light during downshifts.  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Driving with the parking brake on can  
overheat the brake system and cause premature  
wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure  
that the parking brake is fully released and the  
brake warning light is off before driving.  
Parking Brake  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic  
Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow.  
The parking brake lever is located between the bucket  
seats.  
To set the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down  
and pull up on the parking brake lever. If the ignition  
is on, the brake system warning light will come on.  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 428.  
1. Hold the brake pedal down and set the parking  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 328 for more  
information.  
To release the parking brake, hold the brake pedal  
down. Pull the parking brake lever up until you can  
press the release button. Hold the release button in  
as you move the brake lever all the way down.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by pressing the  
button on the shift lever and pushing the lever all  
the way toward the front of the vehicle.  
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.  
If you have to leave the vehicle with the engine running,  
be sure the vehicle is in P (Park) and the parking brake  
is firmly set before you leave it. After you have moved  
the shift lever into P (Park), hold the brake pedal down.  
Then see if you can move the shift lever away from  
P (Park) without first pushing the shift lock release  
button. If you can, it means that the shift lever was not  
fully locked into P (Park).  
4. Remove the key and take it with you. If you can  
leave the vehicle with the ignition key in your hand,  
the vehicle is in P (Park).  
Leaving the Vehicle With the Engine  
Running (Automatic Transmission)  
Torque Lock (Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift your  
transmission into P (Park) properly, the weight of the  
vehicle may put too much force on the parking pawl  
in the transmission. You may find it difficult to pull the  
shift lever out of P (Park). This is called torque lock.”  
To prevent torque lock, set the parking brake and then  
shift into P (Park) properly before you leave the driver  
seat. To find out how, see Shifting Into Park (Automatic  
Transmission) on page 328.  
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the  
engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the  
parking brake firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat  
and even catch fire. You or others could be  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the engine  
running.  
When you are ready to drive, move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) before you release the parking brake.  
If torque lock does occur, you may need to have  
another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take some of  
the pressure from the parking pawl in the transmission,  
so you can pull the shift lever out of P (Park).  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shifting Out of Park  
Vehicles with an automatic transmission have a shift  
interlock system. You have to apply the brake pedal  
before you can shift from P (Park) when the ignition is in  
the ON/RUN position. See Automatic Transmission  
Operation on page 323.  
If you cannot shift out of P (Park) while holding the  
brake pedal down, try this:  
1. Set the parking brake.  
2. Turn the ignition off and remove the key.  
3. Remove the hole cover from the shift lock slot by  
prying it off using a small, flat object. The shift lock  
release slot is located at the top of the shift lever.  
4. Insert the key into the shift lock slot and press and  
hold the key.  
5. Shift to N (Neutral).  
6. Remove the key from the slot, insert the key into  
the ignition and start the engine.  
7. Replace the shift-lock release slot cover.  
8. Apply and hold the brake pedal fully and release  
the parking brake.  
9. Shift to the gear you want.  
10. Have the vehicle fixed as soon as you can.  
3-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking the Vehicle  
(Manual Transmission)  
Parking Over Things That Burn  
WARNING:  
Before leaving the vehicle, do the following:  
{
1. Hold the brake pedal down and firmly apply the  
parking brake.  
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust  
parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things that  
can burn.  
2. Fully press in the clutch pedal and place the shift  
lever into the gear position as stated below:  
.
When parking on level ground, place the shift  
lever into N (Neutral).  
.
When parking downhill, place the shift lever in  
R (Reverse).  
.
When parking uphill, place the shift lever in  
1 (First).  
3. After shifting, turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF,  
remove the key and release the clutch.  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Exhaust  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
The vehicles exhaust system has been  
modified, damaged or improperly repaired.  
Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and even death.  
.
There are holes or openings in the vehicle  
body from damage or after-market  
modifications that are not completely sealed.  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected  
that exhaust is coming into the vehicle:  
.
The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation  
(parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that  
may block underbody airflow or tail pipes).  
.
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
.
The exhaust smells or sounds strange or  
different.  
.
Have the vehicle repaired immediately.  
Never park the vehicle with the engine running in  
an enclosed area such as a garage or a building  
that has no fresh air ventilation.  
.
The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion or  
damage.  
(Continued)  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Running the Vehicle While Parked  
It is better not to park with the engine running. But if you  
ever have to, here are some things to know.  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
automatic transmission shift lever is not fully in  
P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The  
vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you have to. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when it is on  
fairly level ground, always set the parking brake  
and move the automatic transmission shift lever to  
P (Park), or the manual transmission shift lever to  
Neutral.  
WARNING:  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen  
or smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and  
even death. Never run the engine in an enclosed  
area that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 332.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not  
move. If the vehicle has an automatic transmission,  
see Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) on  
page 328  
.
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Outside Manual Mirrors  
Adjust the mirrors to see a little of the side of your  
vehicle.  
Mirrors  
Manual Rearview Mirror  
Hold the inside rearview mirror in the center to move it  
for a clearer view behind your vehicle. Adjust the mirror  
to avoid glare from the headlamps behind you. Push the  
tab forward for daytime use and pull it for nighttime use.  
Controls for the outside manual mirrors are located next  
to each mirror.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold,  
push the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror  
outward, to return it to the original position.  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Outside Power Mirrors  
Outside Convex Mirror  
WARNING:  
The control is located on  
the instrument panel, left  
of the steering wheel.  
{
A convex mirror can make things, like other  
vehicles, look farther away than they really are.  
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you could  
hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside mirror  
or glance over your shoulder before changing  
lanes.  
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex  
mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the  
driver seat.  
The ignition must be turned to ON/RUN to adjust the  
mirrors.  
To adjust the mirrors:  
Outside Heated Mirrors  
For vehicles with this feature:  
1. Select the mirror you want to adjust by moving  
the selector switch to L for the driver side mirror  
or R for the passenger side mirror.  
< (Rear Window Defogger): Press to heat the  
mirrors. See Rear Window and Outside Mirror  
Defoggerunder Climate Control System on page 416  
for more information.  
2. Press one of the four arrows located on the control  
pad to move the mirror to the desired direction.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold,  
push the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror  
outward, to return to its original position.  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cupholders  
Storage Areas  
Two cupholders are located in the center instrument  
panel, below the climate control system. To use the  
cupholder, push in on the cover, then pull it out. After  
use, push in the cupholder until it latches.  
The vehicle may have shopping bag hooks on each  
front seatback. Lift the headrest to access the hooks.  
Glove Box  
Lift up on the glove box lever to open it.  
There is also a cupholder located in the rear of the  
center console.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To fully open the sunroof, press and hold the passenger  
side of the switch. The sunshade opens with the  
sunroof. To close the sunroof, press and hold the driver  
side of the switch. The sunroof will stop if the switch is  
released during operation. Close the sunshade  
manually.  
Sunroof  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the switch is  
located on the headliner  
between the sun visors.  
In both the vent and fully open positions, the air flow  
can be adjusted by pushing and holding the switch until  
the sunroof moves to the desired position.  
The sunroof cannot be opened or closed if the vehicle  
has an electrical failure.  
The sunroof only operates when the ignition is turned to  
ON/RUN. The sunroof can be opened to a vent position  
or it can be opened all of the way.  
Dirt and debris may collect on the sunroof seal or in the  
tracks that could cause an issue with sunroof operation,  
noise or plug the water frainage system. Periodically  
open the sunroof and remove any obstacles or loose  
debris. Wipe the sunroof seal and roof sealing area  
using a clean cloth, mild soap, and water. Do not  
remove grease from sunroof.  
To open the sunroof to the vent position, open the  
sunshade. Then press and hold the driver side of the  
switch. To close the sunroof, press and hold the  
passenger side of the switch until the sunroof reaches  
the desired position.  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . . 4-29  
Hold Mode Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Change Engine Oil Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Cruise Control Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) Indicator  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Instrument Panel Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Accessory Power Outlet(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Fixed Mast Antenna (Hatchback) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Backglass Antenna (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Multi-Band Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Radio with CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45  
Radio with Six-Disc CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Using an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tilt Wheel  
Instrument Panel Overview  
The tilt wheel lever is  
located under the steering  
column, slightly to the left.  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
The hazard warning flasher button is located to the right  
of the climate control system on the sedan.  
| Hazard Warning Flasher: Press to make the front  
and rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. This warns  
others that you are having trouble. Press the button  
again to turn the flashers off.  
When the hazard warning flashers are on, the turn  
signals will not work.  
Horn  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down.  
Press near or on the horn symbols on the steering  
wheel pad to sound the horn.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or down into a  
comfortable position.  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the wheel in place.  
Do not adjust the tilt lever while driving.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
An arrow on the instrument panel cluster flashes in the  
direction of the turn or lane change.  
Move the lever all the way up or down to signal a turn.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
includes the following:  
G : Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
P : Exterior Light Control  
# : Fog Lamps, if equipped  
Flash-to-Pass Feature.  
Information for these features is on the pages following.  
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash to  
signal a lane change. Hold it there until the lane change  
is completed.  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
The headlamps must be on for this feature to work.  
Push the turn signal lever away from you to turn the  
high beams on.  
The lever returns to its starting position whenever it is  
released.  
If after signaling a turn or a lane change the arrow  
flashes rapidly or does not come on, a signal bulb may  
be burned out.  
This instrument panel cluster light 3 comes on while  
the high beams are on and the ignition is turned to  
ON/RUN.  
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb is not burned out,  
check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on  
Pull the lever towards you to return to low beams.  
page 687  
.
Flash-to-Pass  
This feature is used to signal to the vehicle ahead that  
you want to pass.  
Pull the turn signal/multifunction lever towards you until  
the high-beam headlamps come on, then release the  
lever to turn them off.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield Wipers  
Hatchback shown  
The lever is located on the right side of the steering  
column. The ignition must be turned to ON/RUN to  
operate the windshield wipers.  
Sedan shown  
Move the lever to one of the following positions:  
HI (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
LO (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
INT (Intermittent): Move to this position for a delayed  
wiping cycle. Turn the band on the windshield wiper  
toward FAST or SLOW for a shorter or longer delay  
between wipes. The wiper speed can only be adjusted  
when the lever is in the INT position.  
OFF: Turns the windshield wipers off.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Misting Function  
Windshield Washer  
Move the lever toward INT for a single wiping cycle.  
Hold it there until the windshield wipers start; then let  
go. The windshield wipers will stop after one wipe.  
If more wipes are needed, hold the band toward INT  
longer.  
To use this feature, the ignition must be turned to  
ON/RUN. Pull the windshield washer/wiper lever toward  
you to spray washer fluid on the windshield.  
The spray continues until the lever is released. The  
wipers will run a few times and either stop or will  
resume at the speed being used previously. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 633 for information  
on filling the windshield washer fluid.  
Clear ice and snow from the wiper blades before using  
them. If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or  
thaw them. Damaged wiper blades should be replaced.  
See Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
page 650  
.
WARNING:  
{
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wipers. A circuit  
breaker stops them until the motor cools.  
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer  
WARNING:  
Cruise Control  
For vehicles with cruise control, a speed of about  
39 km/h (24 mph) or more can be maintained without  
keeping your foot on the accelerator. Cruise control  
does not work at speeds below 39 km/h (24 mph).  
{
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
When the brakes are applied, or the clutch pedal if you  
have a manual transmission, the cruise control turns off.  
WARNING:  
{
The vehicle may have a rear window wiper/washer.  
Cruise control can be dangerous where you  
cannot drive safely at a steady speed. So, do not  
use the cruise control on winding roads or in  
heavy traffic.  
Turn the rear wiper/washer band to operate the rear  
window wiper/washer.  
OFF: Turns the rear window wiper/washer off.  
Z : Turns the rear wiper on for intermittent wipes.  
Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery  
roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction  
can cause excessive wheel slip, and you could  
lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery  
roads.  
Y : Sprays washer fluid onto the rear window and the  
wiper operates continuously.  
The windshield washer reservoir is used for the  
windshield and rear window. Check the fluid level if  
either washer is not working. See Windshield Washer  
Fluid on page 633.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on the right  
side of the steering wheel.  
Setting Cruise Control  
WARNING:  
{
If you leave your cruise control on when you are  
not using cruise, you might hit a button and go  
into cruise when you do not want to. You could be  
startled and even lose control. Keep the cruise  
control switch off until you want to use cruise  
control.  
I / O (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise control on  
or off.  
1. Press I / O to turn cruise control on.  
2. Accelerate to the speed desired.  
RES+ (Resume/Accelerate): Press to make the  
vehicle accelerate or resume to a previously set speed.  
3. Press the SETbutton and release it. The cruise  
control light comes on in the instrument panel  
cluster to show that the cruise control is on.  
SET(Set/Coast): Press to set the speed or make the  
vehicle decelerate.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerate pedal.  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
If the cruise control is set to a desired speed and then  
the brakes are applied, or the clutch pedal if you have a  
manual transmission, the cruise control shuts off. But it  
does not need to be reset.  
There are two ways to reduce the vehicle speed while  
using cruise control:  
.
Press the SETbutton until the lower speed  
Once the vehicle is going about 39 km/h (24 mph) or  
more, briefly press the RES+ button. The vehicle  
returns to the previously set speed and stays there.  
desired is reached, then release it.  
.
To slow down in small amounts, briefly press the  
SETbutton. Each time this is done, the vehicle  
If the RES+ button is held, the vehicle speed will  
continue to increase until the button is released or the  
brake pedal is applied. Do not hold in the RES+ button,  
unless you want the vehicle to go faster.  
goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.  
Passing Another Vehicle While Using  
Cruise Control  
Use the accelerator pedal to increase the vehicle  
speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the  
vehicle slows down to the cruise control speed set  
earlier.  
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
There are two ways to go to a higher speed.  
.
Use the accelerator pedal to get to a higher speed.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
Press the SETbutton, then release the button  
How well the cruise control works on hills depends upon  
the vehicle speed, load, and the steepness of the hills.  
When going up steep hills, you might have to step on  
the accelerator pedal to maintain the vehicle's speed.  
When going downhill, you might have to brake or shift  
to a lower gear to keep the vehicle's speed down. When  
the brakes are applied the cruise control turns off.  
and the accelerator pedal.  
.
Press the RES+ button. Hold it there until the  
desired speed is reached, and then release it. To  
increase the vehicle speed in small amounts,  
briefly press the RES+ button and then release it.  
Each time this is done, the vehicle goes about  
1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.  
The accelerate feature only works after the cruise  
control is turned on by pressing the SETbutton.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The exterior lamp band has three positions:  
Ending Cruise Control  
3 (Headlamps): Turns on the headlamps, together  
with the following:  
There are two ways to turn off the cruise control:  
.
Step lightly on the brake pedal, or press the clutch  
.
Taillamps  
pedal, if you have a manual transmission.  
.
License Plate Lamp  
.
Press I / O on the cruise control pad.  
.
Instrument Panel Lights  
Erasing Speed Memory  
.
Parking Lamps  
The cruise control set speed memory is erased when  
the cruise control or the ignition is turned off.  
The headlamps automatically turn off when the ignition  
key is turned to LOCK/OFF or ACC/ACCESSORY.  
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the parking lamps,  
together with the taillamps, license plate lamp, and  
instrument panel lights.  
Exterior Lamps  
OFF: Turns all the lamps off, except the Daytime  
Running Lamps (DRL).  
Uplevel shown, Base similar  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the exterior lamps.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The low-beam headlamps are on.  
The flash-to-pass feature is used.  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for  
others to see the front of your vehicle during the day.  
Fully functional daytime running lamps are required on  
all vehicles first sold in Canada.  
The regular headlamp system should be used when  
needed.  
Fog Lamps  
For vehicles with fog lamps, they are controlled by the  
# band located on the middle of the turn signal/  
multifunction lever.  
The DRL system makes the headlamps come on when  
the following conditions are met:  
.
The ignition is on.  
.
The exterior lamp band is in OFF or in the parking  
To use the fog lamps, the ignition must be turned to  
ON/RUN and the low-beam headlamps or parking  
lamps must be on.  
lamp position.  
.
The parking brake is released.  
An indicator light on instrument panel cluster comes on  
when the DRL system is on.  
Turn the band to # to turn the fog lamps on. The band  
automatically returns to its starting position when  
released. The fog lamp indicator light comes on in the  
instrument panel cluster. See Fog Lamp Light on  
When the DRL system is on, the taillamps, sidemarker  
lamps, parking lamps and instrument panel lights do not  
come on unless the exterior lamps control is turned to  
the parking lamp or headlamp position.  
page 435  
.
To turn the fog lamps off, turn the band to # again. The  
fog lamp indicator light will go off.  
The DRL system turns off when one of the following  
conditions are met:  
The fog lamps will also turn off when the high-beam  
headlamps are turned on. When the high-beam  
headlamps are turned off, the fog lamps will turn on  
again.  
.
The ignition is off.  
.
The parking brake is on.  
.
The high-beam headlamps are on.  
Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to  
be on along with the fog lamps.  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Brightness  
Dome Lamp  
This feature controls the brightness of the instrument  
panel lights.  
The vehicle has a dome lamp located in the overhead  
console.  
Move the switch to the following positions:  
ON: The light comes on and stays on.  
O (Door): The light comes on when a door is opened.  
The light turns off when all the doors are closed.  
OFF: The light remains off even when a door is  
opened.  
Be sure all doors and trunk lid or hatch are completely  
closed or the battery may drain.  
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver  
The thumbwheel for this feature is located on the  
instrument panel to the left of the steering column. Turn  
the thumbwheel to brighten or dim the lights.  
This feature is designed to protect the vehicle's battery  
against drainage. If the exterior lamps control is left in  
the ; or 2 position, the key is removed and the driver  
door is opened, the lights will turn off automatically.  
If the key is removed and the driver door is opened  
while the dome lamp is on, the dome lamp will not turn  
off automatically.  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible  
with the accessory power outlet and could result in  
blown vehicle or adapter fuses. If you experience a  
problem, see your dealer/retailer for additional  
information on accessory power outlets.  
Accessory Power Outlet(s)  
Accessory power outlets can be used to plug in  
auxiliary electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
The accessory power outlet is located next to the  
parking brake on the center console.  
Notice: Adding any electrical equipment to the  
vehicle can damage it or keep other components  
from working as they should. The repairs would not  
be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating of  
20 amperes. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding electrical equipment.  
To use the accessory power outlet, remove the  
protective cap. When not in use, always cover the outlet  
with the protective cap. The accessory power outlet is  
operational when the ignition is turned to ACC/  
ACCESSORY or ON/RUN.  
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment on for  
extended periods will drain the battery. Always turn  
off electrical equipment when not in use and do not  
plug in equipment that exceeds the  
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the  
proper installation instructions included with the  
equipment.  
maximum amperage rating.  
Notice: Improper use of the power outlet can cause  
damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not  
hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the power outlets are  
designed for accessory power plugs only.  
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter  
Clock  
The ashtray is located at the lower part of the center  
instrument panel. To remove the front ashtray for  
cleaning, open the ashtray fully, press in the retaining  
tab and pull the bin out.  
There is a digital clock located in the center of the  
instrument panel, above the center air outlets. When the  
ignition is turned to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, the  
time is displayed in the digital clock. There are three  
buttons for adjusting the digital clock:  
Notice: If papers, pins, or other flammable items are  
put in the ashtray, hot cigarettes or other smoking  
materials could ignite them and possibly damage  
the vehicle. Never put flammable items in the  
ashtray.  
H (Hour): Press once to go forward one hour. To go  
forward more than one hour, press and hold the button  
until the correct hour is reached.  
M (Minute): Press once to go forward one minute. To go  
forward more than one minute, press and hold the  
button until the correct minute is reached.  
The cigarette lighter is located to the right of the  
front ashtray. To use it, turn the ignition to  
ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN, push the cigarette  
lighter in all the way and let go. When it is ready,  
it will pop back out.  
S (Set): Press to reset the time to the nearest hour.  
For example, if the set button is pressed while the time  
is between 8:00 and 8:29, the display is set to 8:00.  
If this button is pressed while the time is between  
8:30 and 8:59, the display is set to 9:00.  
Electrical accessories may not be compatible with the  
cigarette lighter and could result in blown vehicle or  
adapter fuses. If you experience a problem see your  
dealer/retailer for additional information.  
After disconnecting the battery or replacing the fuse,  
reset the clock.  
Notice: Holding a cigarette lighter in while it is  
heating will not allow the lighter to back away from  
the heating element when it is hot. Damage from  
overheating may occur to the lighter or heating  
element. Do not hold a cigarette lighter in while it is  
heating.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
Climate Control System  
For vehicles with these climate control systems, the  
heating, cooling, and ventilation can be controlled for  
the vehicle.  
Climate Control System with Heater Only  
A. Temperature Control D. Rear Window  
Defogger  
B. Fan Control  
E. Outside Air/  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Recirculation  
Control  
Climate Control System with Heater and Air  
Conditioning  
A. Temperature Control D. Air Conditioning (A/C)  
B. Fan Control  
E. Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
F. Rear Window  
Defogger  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OFF: Turns the fan off.  
É (Defog): This mode clears the windows of fog or  
moisture. Air is directed to the windshield, floor, and  
side window outlets. When this mode is selected, the  
system automatically runs the air-conditioning. To defog  
the windows faster, turn the temperature control to the  
warmest setting.  
Temperature Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to increase or decrease the  
temperature of the air flowing from the system.  
9 (Fan Control): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise  
to increase or decrease the fan speed. The fan must be  
turned on to run the air conditioning compressor.  
1 (Defrost): This mode quickly clears the windshield  
of fog or frost. Air is directed to the windshield and side  
window outlets. When this mode is selected, the system  
automatically runs the air-conditioning. To defrost the  
windows faster, turn the temperature control to the  
warmest setting.  
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to change the current airflow mode.  
Select from the following air delivery modes:  
Y (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel outlets.  
Do not drive the vehicle until all the windows are clear.  
\ (Bi-Level): Air is divided between the instrument  
A/C (Air Conditioning): For vehicles with air  
panel and floor outlets.  
conditioning, follow these steps to use the system.  
[ (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some  
air directed to the rear outlets. Keep the area under the  
front seats clear to allow the flow of air to the rear  
compartment.  
Turn 9 to the desired speed. The air conditioning does  
not operate when the fan control knob is in the off  
position. Press A/C to turn the air conditioning on and  
off. When A/C is pressed, an indicator light comes on to  
show that the air conditioning is on.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For quick cool down on hot days, do the following:  
1. Open the windows to let hot air escape.  
For vehicles with a recirculation button, press the button  
to turn the recirculation mode on. An indicator light  
comes on to show that the recirculation is on. Press the  
button again to return to outside air mode.  
2. Press ? .  
3. Press A/C.  
For vehicles with a lever, move the lever to choose the  
recirculation mode.  
4. Select the coolest temperature.  
Using the recirculation mode for extended periods may  
cause the windows to fog. If this happens, select the  
defrost mode.  
5. Select the highest 9 speed.  
Using these settings together for long periods of time  
may cause the air inside of the vehicle to become too  
dry. To prevent this from happening, after the air in the  
vehicle has cooled, turn the recirculation mode off.  
: (Outside Air): This mode brings outside air into the  
vehicle.  
For vehicles with a recirculation button, press the button  
until the recirculation mode is turned off. The vehicle  
then returns to the outside air mode.  
The air conditioning system removes moisture from the  
air, so a small amount of water might drip under the  
vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine. This  
is normal.  
For vehicles with a lever, move the lever to choose the  
outside air mode.  
? (Recirculation): This mode recirculates and helps  
to quickly cool the air inside the vehicle. It can be used  
to prevent outside air and odors from entering the  
vehicle.  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Window and Outside Mirror  
Defogger  
For vehicles with a rear window and outside mirror  
defogger, they only work when the ignition is turned to  
ON/RUN.  
Outlet Adjustment  
To open an outlet, press on its cover. Turn the cover to  
change the direction of the airflow.  
Operation Tips  
.
Clear away any ice, snow or leaves from the air  
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to  
remove fog or frost from the rear window.  
inlets at the base of the windshield that may block  
the flow of air into the vehicle.  
< (Rear Window Defogger): Press to turn the rear  
window and outside mirror defogger on or off. An  
indicator light comes on to show that the feature is on.  
.
Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors may  
adversely affect the performance of the system.  
.
Keep the path under the front seats clear of  
objects to help circulate the air inside of the vehicle  
more effectively.  
If the vehicle does not have air conditioning, the rear  
window defogger may turn off about 10 minutes after  
the button is pressed. If it remains on, it can be turned  
off by pressing < again or by turning off the engine.  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
For vehicles with a passenger compartment air filter, it  
is located behind the glove box. It can be accessed  
after removing the glove box from its housing.  
If the vehicle has air conditioning, the rear window  
defogger turns off about 10 minutes after the button is  
pressed. The defogger can also be turned off by turning  
the engine off.  
Pollen and dust are removed by the filter. The filter  
should be replaced as part of routine scheduled  
maintenance. For a replacement filter see your dealer/  
retailer. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for  
replacement intervals.  
Notice: Do not use anything sharp on the inside of  
the rear window. If you do, you could cut or damage  
the warming grid, and the repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not attach a  
temporary vehicle license, tape, a decal or anything  
similar to the defogger grid.  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change the passenger compartment air filter, use the  
following steps:  
3. Remove the filter cover by pressing in on the  
bottom retaining tab and pulling the cover down.  
1. Open the glove box halfway down.  
2. Grip the glove box by both the upper and lower  
sides and pull it out of its housing.  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is  
wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an  
expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gauges could prevent injury.  
Warning lights come on when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Some  
warning lights come on briefly when the engine is  
started to indicate they are working.  
Gauges can indicate when there might be or there is a  
problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Often  
gauges and warning lights work together to indicate a  
problem with the vehicle.  
4. Replace the air conditioner filter.  
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on  
while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there  
could be a problem, check the section that explains  
what to do. Follow this manual's advice. Waiting to do  
repairs can be costly and even dangerous.  
5. View the air flow arrows on the filter before  
installing to ensure the filter is installed correctly.  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Cluster  
United States Manual Transmission shown, Canada and Automatic Transmission Similar  
4-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speedometer and Odometer  
Tachometer  
The speedometer shows the vehicle's speed in both  
kilometers per hour (km/h) and miles per hour (mph).  
The odometer shows how far the vehicle has been  
driven, in either kilometers (used in Canada) or miles  
(used in the United States).  
Trip Odometer  
The trip odometer can record the number of miles, used  
in the United States, or kilometers, used in Canada,  
traveled for up to two trips.  
Cycle between the odometer and trip odometers A  
and B by pressing the reset button located in the lower  
right area of the speedometer. Press the reset button to  
tell how many miles or kilometers have been recorded  
on either Trip A or Trip B since the trip odometer was  
last set back to zero.  
The tachometer displays the engine speed in  
revolutions per minute (rpm).  
Notice: If the engine is operated above 6,500 rpm,  
the vehicle could be damaged, and the damages  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do  
not operate the engine with the tachometer above  
6,500 rpm.  
To reset each trip odometer to zero, press and hold the  
reset button. The reset button resets only the trip  
odometer that is being displayed. Each trip odometer  
must be reset individually.  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger Safety Belt Reminder Light  
Safety Belt Reminders  
For vehicles equipped with the passenger safety belt  
reminder light, several seconds after the engine is  
started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind  
the front passenger to buckle their safety belt. The  
passenger safety belt light, located on the instrument  
panel, comes on and stays on for several seconds and  
then flashes for several more.  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder Light  
When the engine is started, a chime sounds for several  
seconds to remind a driver to fasten the safety belt,  
unless the driver safety belt is already buckled.  
The safety belt light  
comes on and stays on  
for several seconds, then  
flashes for several more.  
This chime and light are  
repeated if the passenger  
remains unbuckled and  
the vehicle is in motion.  
This chime and light are repeated if the driver remains  
unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion. If the driver  
safety belt is already buckled, neither the chime nor the  
light comes on.  
If the passenger safety belt is buckled, neither the  
chime nor the light comes on.  
The front passenger safety belt warning light and chime  
may turn on if an object is put on the seat such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device. To turn off the warning light and or  
chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the  
safety belt.  
4-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
WARNING:  
{
There is an airbag readiness light on the instrument  
panel cluster, which shows the airbag symbol. The  
system checks the airbag's electrical system for  
malfunctions. The light tells if there is an electrical  
problem. The system check includes the airbag sensor,  
the airbag modules, the wiring and the crash sensing  
and diagnostic module. For more information on the  
airbag system, see Airbag System on page 258.  
If the airbag readiness light stays on after the  
vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it  
means the airbag system might not be working  
properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not  
inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the  
vehicle serviced right away.  
This light comes on when  
the vehicle is started, and  
it will flash for a few  
seconds. When the light  
goes out this indicates the  
system is functioning  
properly.  
If the airbag readiness light stays on or comes on while  
driving, the airbag system may not work properly. Have  
the vehicle serviced right away.  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the words PASSENGER AIRBAG ON or the on  
symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it  
means that the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped) is  
enabled (may inflate).  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  
The vehicle has the passenger sensing system. See  
Passenger Sensing System on page 265 for important  
safety information. The vehicle has a passenger airbag  
status indicator near the clock, located in the center of  
the instrument panel.  
If the words PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF or the off  
symbol is lit on the passenger airbag status indicator, it  
means that the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped).  
If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights  
remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be a  
problem with the lights or the passenger sensing  
system. See your dealer/retailer for service.  
United States  
Canada  
WARNING:  
{
When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag  
status indicator will light PASSENGER AIRBAG ON and  
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF or the symbol for on and  
off, for several seconds as a system check. Then, after  
several more seconds, the status indicator will light  
either PASSENGER AIRBAG ON or PASSENGER  
AIRBAG OFF, or either the on or off symbol, to let you  
know the status of the right front passenger frontal and  
seat-mounted side impact airbag (if equipped).  
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 425  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
4-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charging System Light  
Up-Shift Light  
The vehicle may have an  
up-shift light.  
This light will come on briefly when the ignition is turned  
on, and the engine is not running, as a check to show it  
is working.  
When this light comes on, shift to the next higher gear if  
weather, road, and traffic conditions allow.  
See Manual Transmission Operation on page 326 for  
more information.  
It should go out when the engine is started. If it stays  
on, or comes on while driving, there may have a  
problem with the electrical charging system. Have it  
checked by your dealer/retailer. Driving while this light is  
on could drain the battery. If a short distance must be  
driven with the light on, turn off all accessories, such as  
the radio and air conditioner to help reduce the drain on  
the battery.  
4-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brake System Warning Light  
WARNING:  
{
The vehicle's hydraulic brake system is divided into two  
parts. If one part is not working, the other part can still  
work and stop the vehicle. For good braking, both parts  
need to work.  
The brake system might not be working properly if  
the brake system warning light is on. Driving with  
the brake system warning light on can lead to a  
crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has  
been pulled off the road and carefully stopped,  
have the vehicle towed for service.  
If the warning light comes on, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected right away.  
This light should come on briefly when the ignition is  
turned to ON. If it does not come on then, have it fixed  
so it will be ready to warn if there is a problem.  
When the ignition is on, the brake system warning light  
will also come on when the parking brake is set. The  
light will stay on if the parking brake does not fully  
release. If it stays on after the parking brake is fully  
released, it means there is a brake problem.  
United States  
Canada  
If the light comes on while driving, carefully pull off the  
road and stop. The pedal may be harder to push or may  
go closer to the floor. It may take longer to stop. If the  
light is still on, have the vehicle towed for service. See  
Towing Your Vehicle on page 521.  
4-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light  
Hold Mode Light  
If the vehicle has this  
feature, this light comes  
on when the hold mode is  
active.  
For vehicles with the  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), this light comes on  
briefly when the engine is  
started.  
If the HOLD mode light flashes, have the vehicle  
checked. See Hold Modeunder Automatic  
Transmission Operation on page 323 for more  
information.  
If the light stays on, turn the ignition to LOCK/OFF or if  
the light comes on, stop as soon as possible and turn  
the ignition off. Then start the engine again to reset the  
system. If the light still stays on, or comes on again  
while driving, the vehicle needs service. See your  
dealer/retailer. If the regular brake system warning light  
is not on, the brakes will still work, but the antilock  
brakes will not work. If the regular brake system  
warning light is also on, the antilock brakes will not work  
and there is a problem with the regular brakes. See  
Brake System Warning Light on page 428.  
The ABS warning light will come on briefly when the  
ignition is turned to ON/RUN. This is normal. If the light  
does not come on then, have it fixed so it will be ready  
to warn if there is a problem.  
4-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
Tire Pressure Light  
For vehicles with the tire  
pressure monitoring  
system, this light comes  
on briefly when the engine  
is started.  
It provides information about tire pressures and the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System.  
When the Light is On Steady  
United States  
Canada  
This indicates that one or more of the tires are  
significantly underinflated.  
The vehicle has an engine coolant temperature gauge.  
With the ignition turned to ON/RUN, this gauge shows  
the engine coolant temperature.  
Stop and check the tires as soon as it is safe to do, and  
inflate them to the proper pressure. See Tires on  
page 651 for more information.  
If the gauge pointer moves into the red area, the engine  
is too hot. It means that the engine coolant has  
overheated.  
When the Light Flashes First and Then is  
On Steady  
If the vehicle has been operating under normal driving  
conditions, pull off the road, stop the vehicle and turn off  
the engine as soon as possible.  
This indicates that there may be a problem with the Tire  
Pressure Monitor System. The light flashes for about a  
minute and then stays on steady for the remainder of  
the ignition cycle. This sequence will repeat with every  
ignition cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor System on  
page 659 for more information.  
See Engine Overheating on page 630.  
4-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If the vehicle is continually driven with this  
light on, after a while, the emission controls might  
not work as well, the vehicle's fuel economy might  
not be as good, and the engine might not run as  
smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
Check Engine Light  
A computer system called OBD II (On-Board  
Diagnostics-Second Generation) monitors operation of  
the fuel, ignition, and emission control systems.  
It makes sure that emissions are at acceptable levels  
for the life of the vehicle, helping to produce a cleaner  
environment.  
Notice: Modifications made to the engine,  
transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system of the  
vehicle or the replacement of the original tires with  
other than those of the same Tire Performance  
Criteria (TPC) can affect the vehicle's emission  
controls and can cause this light to come on.  
Modifications to these systems could lead to costly  
repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty. This  
could also result in a failure to pass a required  
Emission Inspection/Maintenance test. See  
Accessories and Modifications on page 64.  
This light comes on when  
the ignition is on, but the  
engine is not running, as  
a check to show it is  
working. If it does not,  
have the vehicle serviced  
by your dealer/retailer.  
This light comes on during a malfunction in one of  
two ways:  
If the check engine light comes on and stays on, while  
the engine is running, this indicates that there is an  
OBD II problem and service is required.  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition has been detected.  
A misfire increases vehicle emissions and could  
damage the emission control system on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by the system before  
any problem is apparent. Heeding the light can prevent  
more serious damage to the vehicle. This system  
assists the service technician in correctly diagnosing  
any malfunction.  
4-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
If the vehicle has been driven through a deep  
puddle of water, the vehicle's electrical system  
might be wet. The condition is usually corrected  
when the electrical system dries out. A few driving  
trips should turn the light off.  
The following can prevent more serious damage to the  
vehicle:  
.
Reduce vehicle speed.  
.
Avoid hard accelerations.  
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
Make sure to fuel the vehicle with quality fuel. Poor  
fuel quality causes the engine not to run as  
efficiently as designed and may cause: stalling  
after start-up, stalling when the vehicle is changed  
into gear, misfiring, hesitation on acceleration,  
or stumbling on acceleration. These conditions  
might go away once the engine is warmed up.  
If the light continues to flash, when it is safe to do so,  
stop the vehicle. Find a safe place to park the vehicle.  
Turn the key off, wait at least 10 seconds, and restart  
the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the  
previous steps and see your dealer/retailer for service  
as soon as possible.  
If one or more of these conditions occurs, change  
the fuel brand used. It will require at least one full  
tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.  
Light On Steady: An emission control system  
malfunction has been detected on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
See Gasoline Octane on page 66.  
An emission system malfunction might be corrected by  
doing the following:  
If none of the above have made the light turn off, have  
your dealer/retailer check the vehicle. The dealer/  
retailer has the proper test equipment and diagnostic  
tools to fix any mechanical or electrical problems that  
might have developed.  
.
Make sure the fuel cap is fully installed. See Filling  
the Tank on page 68. The diagnostic system  
can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or  
improperly installed. A loose or missing fuel cap  
allows fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few  
driving trips with the cap properly installed should  
turn the light off.  
4-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance  
Programs  
Some state/provincial and local governments have or  
might begin programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on the vehicle. Failure to pass this  
Oil Pressure Light  
If the vehicle has low  
engine oil pressure, this  
light will stay on after the  
engine is started, or come  
on while driving.  
inspection could prevent getting a vehicle registration.  
Here are some things to know to help the vehicle pass  
an inspection:  
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
check engine light is on with the engine running,  
or if the key is in the ON/RUN and the light is  
not on.  
This indicates that the engine is not receiving enough  
oil. The engine could be low on oil, or could have some  
other oil problem. Have it fixed immediately by your  
dealer/retailer.  
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
OBD II (on-board diagnostic) system determines  
that critical emission control systems have not  
been completely diagnosed by the system. The  
vehicle would be considered not ready for  
inspection. This can happen if the battery has  
recently been replaced or if the battery has run  
down. The diagnostic system is designed to  
evaluate critical emission control systems during  
normal driving. This can take several days of  
routine driving. If this has been done and the  
vehicle still does not pass the inspection for lack of  
OBD II system readiness, your dealer/retailer can  
prepare the vehicle for inspection.  
4-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The oil light could also come on in three other  
situations:  
Change Engine Oil Light  
.
When the ignition is on but the engine is not  
running, the light will come on as a test to show it  
is working. The light will go out when the ignition is  
turned on. If it does not come on with the ignition  
on, there may be a problem with the fuse or bulb.  
Have it fixed right away.  
.
If the vehicle comes to a hard stop, the light may  
come on for a moment. This is normal.  
The vehicle may have an engine oil life system that  
indicates when the oil needs to be changed.  
WARNING:  
{
When the change engine oil light comes on, it means  
that the engine oil needs to be changed.  
Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low. The  
engine can become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check the oil as soon  
as possible and have the vehicle serviced.  
Once the engine oil has been changed, the engine oil  
life system must be reset. After reset, the change  
engine oil light goes out.  
See Engine Oil Life System on page 618, Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 and Engine Oil on  
page 615 for more information.  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil maintenance can  
damage the engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Always follow the  
maintenance schedule in this manual for changing  
engine oil.  
4-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fog Lamp Light  
Highbeam On Light  
For vehicles with this  
feature, the fog lamps  
light will come on when  
the fog lamps are in use.  
This light comes on when  
the high-beam headlamps  
are in use.  
The light will go out when the fog lamps are turned off.  
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer on page 45  
See Fog Lamps on page 412 for more information.  
for more information.  
Cruise Control Light  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
Indicator Light  
If the vehicle has cruise  
control, this light comes  
on whenever the cruise  
control is set  
This light turns on  
whenever the Daytime  
Running Lamps are on.  
The light will go out when the cruise control is turned  
off. See Cruise Control on page 48 for more  
information.  
See Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 412 for  
more information.  
4-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Ajar Light  
Fuel Gauge  
The door ajar light comes  
on and stays on until all  
doors, trunk and liftgate  
are closed and completely  
latched.  
United States  
Canada  
If the key is in the ignition while the driver's door is  
open, a warning chime also sounds.  
The fuel gauge indicates about how much fuel is left  
when the ignition is turned to ON/RUN.  
When the tank nears empty, the low fuel warning light  
will come on. There is still a little fuel left, but the  
vehicle's fuel tank should be filled soon. See Low Fuel  
Warning Light on page 437 for more information.  
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates the side of the  
vehicle the fuel door is located.  
4-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are four things that some owners ask about. None  
of these show a problem with the fuel gauge:  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
This light comes on when  
the vehicle is low on fuel.  
.
At the service station, the gas pump shuts off  
before the gauge reads full.  
.
It takes a little more or less fuel to fill up than the  
gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may  
have indicated the tank was half full, but it actually  
took a little more or less than half the tank's  
capacity to fill the tank.  
.
The indicator moves a little when turning a corner  
The low fuel warning light comes on when there is  
approximately 1.7 gallons (6.0 liters) of fuel remaining in  
the tank.  
or speeding up.  
.
The gauge goes back to empty when the ignition is  
turned off.  
To turn the light off, add fuel to the fuel tank. See Filling  
the Tank on page 68.  
4-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For example, if driving in traffic and making frequent  
stops, this display may read one number, but if the  
vehicle is driven on a freeway, the number may change  
even though the same amount of fuel is in the fuel tank.  
This is because different driving conditions produce  
different fuel economies. Generally, freeway driving  
produces better fuel economy than city driving.  
Trip Computer  
The vehicle may have trip computer, it provides the  
driver with driving information such as the driving  
distance for the remaining fuel, outside temperature,  
average fuel economy, and driving time.  
The trip computer button is located in the lower right  
area of the tachometer. Each time you press it, the  
display cycles through the available choices.  
Outside Temperature  
This display shows the approximate outside  
temperature.  
Range for Remaining Fuel  
This display shows the  
approximate number of  
remaining miles the  
vehicle can be driven  
without refueling.  
Average Fuel Economy  
This display shows the  
approximate average  
miles per gallon (mpg).  
The minimum display for the range is 45 miles  
(72 km). Once the minimum display range is under  
45 miles (72 km), you will see dashes on the display.  
This number is calculated based on the number of mpg  
recorded since the last time this menu item was reset.  
To reset the average fuel economy press and hold the  
trip computer button.  
The fuel range estimate is based on an average of  
the vehicle's fuel economy over recent driving history  
and the amount of fuel remaining in the fuel tank.  
This estimate will change if driving conditions change.  
4-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This system provides access to many audio and non  
audio listings.  
Driving Time  
This display can be used  
as a timer.  
To minimize taking your eyes off the road while driving,  
do the following while the vehicle is parked:  
.
Become familiar with the operation and controls of  
the audio system.  
.
Set up the tone, speaker adjustments, and preset  
radio stations.  
For more information, see Defensive Driving on  
page 52  
.
The display will show the amount of time that has  
passed since the timer was last reset. The timer is only  
running while the vehicle is moving. To reset the driving  
time press and hold the trip computer button.  
Notice: Contact your dealer/retailer before adding  
any equipment.  
Adding audio or communication equipment could  
interfere with the operation of the vehicle's engine,  
radio, or other systems, and could damage them.  
Follow federal rules covering mobile radio and  
telephone equipment.  
Audio System(s)  
Determine which radio the vehicle has and read the  
following pages to become familiar with its features.  
WARNING:  
{
Taking your eyes off the road for extended periods  
could cause a crash resulting in injury or death to  
you or others. Do not give extended attention to  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
4-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding a Station  
AM-FM Radio  
BAND: Press to choose FM, AM, or XM(if  
equipped). The display will show the selection.  
u SEEK: Press to seek the next radio station with a  
strong signal in the selected band.  
t SEEK: Press to seek the previous radio station with  
a strong signal in the selected band.  
[ TUNE: Press to go to the next station manually.  
r TUNE: Press to go to the previous station manually.  
SCAN: Press to scan radio stations. The radio goes to  
a station, plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
station. Press this button again to stop scanning.  
The radio only scans stations with a strong signal in the  
selected band.  
AST (Automatic Store): Twelve preset stations with  
the strongest reception in the area can be automatically  
stored. The radio will only scan stations with a strong  
signal that are in the selected AM or FM band. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the FM band, only  
FM stations are stored in preset pages A1 and A2. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the AM band, only  
AM stations are stored in A1 and A2. A combination of  
AM, FM and XM (if equipped) stations can be stored  
manually into the other four favorite pages.  
Playing the Radio  
O (Power/Volume) : Press and release to turn the  
system on. Press and hold this knob for more than  
two seconds to turn the system off.  
Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
When the system is on, press and release O to mute  
the system. Press and release O again to turn the  
sound back on.  
4-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use Automatic Store:  
Storing a Radio Station  
1. Press and hold AST to use Auto Store mode.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations  
using the pushbuttons, favorites button, and steering  
wheel controls. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the ON tab on the  
radio display.  
3. Automatic Store searches for radio stations with a  
strong signal and automatically set presets A1 and  
A2 with new stations.  
A maximum of 36 stations can be programmed as  
favorites using the six pushbuttons positioned below the  
radio station frequency labels and by using the radio  
favorites page button (FAV button). Press the FAV  
button to go through up to six pages of favorites, each  
having six favorite stations available per page.  
If Automatic Store is used, then four pages of favorites  
are available. Each page of favorites can contain any  
combination of AM, FM, or XM(if equipped) stations.  
To store a station as a favorite:  
4. After all stations are set, press the pushbutton  
below the arrow tab on the radio display to return  
to the main radio screen  
To reset the automatically stored radio stations, press  
and hold AST. Then press the pushbutton below the  
RESE tab on the radio display. If no stations are stored  
on preset pages A1 and A2, the RESE option does not  
appear in the radio display. When the Automatic Store  
function is used, any stations that were previously set  
will be deleted and replaced with new stations.  
1. Tune in the desired station.  
2. Press and release the FAV button to display the  
page where the station is to be stored.  
3. Press and hold one of the six numbered  
pushbuttons until a beep sounds. When the  
pushbutton is pressed and released, the station  
that was set will return.  
4. Repeat the Steps 1 through 3 for each radio  
station to be stored as a favorite.  
4-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To setup the number of favorites pages:  
Adjusting the Midrange  
To adjust the midrange:  
1. Press SOUND.  
1. Press and hold FAV until the radio setup menu  
displays.  
2. Select the desired number of favorites pages by  
pressing the pushbutton located below the  
displayed page numbers.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Mid tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press FAV to return to the original main radio  
screen showing the radio station frequency tabs  
and to begin the process of programming favorites  
for the chosen amount of numbered pages.  
Adjusting the Treble  
To adjust the treble:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Mid/Treble)  
SOUND (Bass/Mid/Treble): Press to adjust the bass,  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Treb tab on the  
display.  
midrange, or treble.  
Adjusting the Bass  
To adjust the bass:  
1. Press SOUND.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bass tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
Setting the EQ  
SOUND (Balance/Fade): Press to adjust the balance  
SOUND (Equalization): Press to select an equalization  
or fade.  
setting.  
Adjusting the Balance  
To adjust the balance:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the EQ  
To set the EQ:  
1. Press SOUND.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bal tab on the  
display.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the P.EQ tab on the  
display. The Pop, Rock, Ctry, Voice, Jazz, Clas  
tabs appear on the display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press the pushbutton below the desired selection  
to set the EQ. Pressing the same pushbutton again  
cancels the EQ setting.  
Adjusting the Fade  
To adjust the fade:  
1. Press SOUND.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Fad tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or call  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable to the radio's 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary  
input jack. When a device is connected, press the radio  
AUX button to begin playing audio from the device over  
the vehicle speakers.  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume.  
Additional volume adjustments may have to be made  
from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or  
too loud.  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
See XM Radio Messages on page 463 later in this  
section for further detail.  
AUX (Auxiliary): Press to listen to the radio while a  
portable audio device is playing. Press again and the  
system begins playing audio from the connected  
portable audio player. If a portable audio player is not  
connected, No Aux Input Device Found may display.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system has a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input  
jack located on the lower right side of the faceplate.  
This is not an audio output; do not plug headphones  
into the 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input jack. An external  
audio device such as an iPod®, laptop computer, MP3  
player, CD changer, etc. can be connected to the  
3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input jack for use as another  
audio source.  
4-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding a Station  
Radio with CD  
BAND: Press to choose FM, AM, or XM™  
(if equipped). The display will show the selection.  
u SEEK: Press to seek the next radio station with a  
strong signal in the selected band.  
t SEEK: Press to seek the previous radio station with  
a strong signal in the selected band.  
[ TUNE: Press to go to the next station manually.  
r TUNE: Press to go to the previous station manually.  
SCAN/AST: Press to scan radio stations. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then goes to  
the next station. The radio only scans stations with a  
strong signal in the selected band. Press SCAN/AST  
again to stop scanning.  
Press and hold SCAN/AST to use Auto Store. The  
radio only scans stations with a strong signal in the  
selected band.  
Playing the Radio  
O (Power/Volume): Press and release to turn the  
system on. Press and hold this knob for more than  
two seconds to turn the system off.  
Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
When the system is on, press and release O to mute  
the system. Press and release O again to turn the  
sound back on.  
4-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AST (Automatic Store): Twelve preset stations with  
the strongest reception in the area can be automatically  
stored. The radio will only scan stations with a strong  
signal that are in the selected AM or FM band. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the FM band, only  
FM stations are stored in preset pages A1 and A2. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the AM band, only  
AM stations are stored in A1 and A2. A combination of  
AM, FM and XM (if equipped) stations can be stored  
manually into the other four favorite pages.  
Automatic Store function is used, any stations that were  
previously set will be deleted and replaced with new  
stations.  
Storing a Radio Station  
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations  
using the pushbuttons, favorites button, and steering  
wheel controls. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
A maximum of 36 stations can be programmed as  
favorites using the six pushbuttons positioned below the  
radio station frequency labels and by using the radio  
favorites page button (FAV button). Press the FAV  
button to go through up to six pages of favorites, each  
having six favorite stations available per page.  
If Automatic Store is used, then four pages of favorites  
are available. Each page of favorites can contain any  
combination of AM, FM, or XM(if equipped) stations.  
To store a station as a favorite:  
To use Automatic Store:  
1. Press and hold SCAN/AST to use Auto  
Store mode.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the ON tab on the  
radio display.  
3. Automatic Store searches for radio stations with a  
strong signal and automatically set presets A1 and  
A2 with new stations.  
4. After all stations are set, press the pushbutton  
below the arrow tab on the radio display to return  
to the main radio screen  
1. Tune in the desired station.  
2. Press and release the FAV button to display the  
page where the station is to be stored.  
To reset the automatically stored radio stations, press  
and hold SCAN/AST. Then press the pushbutton below  
the RESE tab on the radio display. If no stations are  
stored on preset pages A1 and A2, the RESE option  
does not appear in the radio display. When the  
3. Press and hold one of the six numbered  
pushbuttons until a beep sounds. When the  
pushbutton is pressed and released, the station  
that was set will return.  
4. Repeat the Steps 1 through 3 for each radio  
station to be stored as a favorite.  
4-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To setup the number of favorites pages:  
Adjusting the Midrange  
To adjust the midrange:  
1. Press SOUND.  
1. Press and hold FAV until the radio setup menu  
displays.  
2. Select the desired number of favorites pages by  
pressing the pushbutton located below the  
displayed page numbers.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Mid tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press FAV to return to the original main radio  
screen showing the radio station frequency tabs  
and to begin the process of programming favorites  
for the chosen amount of numbered pages.  
Adjusting the Treble  
To adjust the treble:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Mid/Treble)  
SOUND (Bass/Mid/Treble): Press to adjust the bass,  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Treb tab on the  
display.  
midrange, or treble.  
Adjusting the Bass  
To adjust the bass:  
1. Press SOUND.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bass tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
Setting the EQ  
SOUND (Balance/Fade): Press to adjust the balance  
SOUND (Equalization): Press to select an equalization  
or fade.  
setting.  
Adjusting the Balance  
To adjust the balance:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the EQ  
To set the EQ:  
1. Press SOUND.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bal tab on the  
display.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the P.EQ tab on the  
display. The Pop, Rock, Ctry, Voice, Jazz, Clas  
tabs appear on the display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press the pushbutton below the desired selection  
to set the EQ. Pressing the same pushbutton again  
cancels the EQ setting.  
Adjusting the Fade  
To adjust the fade:  
1. Press SOUND.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Fad tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the  
player, it will stay in the player. When a CD is in the  
player and the ignition is in the ON/RUN position, the  
radio must be turned on before the CD will start playing.  
When the ignition and radio are turned on, the CD will  
start playing where it stopped, if it was the last selected  
audio source.  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety of  
programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or call  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
The CD player can play the smaller 8 cm (3 in) single  
CDs with an adapter ring. Full-size CDs and the smaller  
CDs are loaded in the same manner.  
[ TUNE (Next Track): Press [ TUNE to go to the  
next track. The track number will appear on the display.  
The player will continue moving forward through the CD  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
See XM Radio Messages on page 463 later in this  
section for further detail.  
with each press of [ TUNE.  
r TUNE (Previous Track): Press to go to the start of  
the current track. The track number will appear on the  
display. The player will continue moving backward  
Playing a CD  
Insert a CD partway into the slot, label side up. The  
player pulls it in and the CD begins playing. A CD can  
be loaded while the ignition is in the OFF position.  
through the CD with each press of r TUNE.  
When the CD is inserted, CDP appears on the display.  
As the CD is loading, LOADING appears on the display.  
As each new track starts to play, the track number  
displays.  
4-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a CD is  
playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
RPT (Repeat): Press the pushbutton under the RPT tab  
on the display to repeat the current track, RPT appears  
on the display. Press the pushbutton again to stop  
repeat.  
CD/AUX: Press to play a CD when listening to the  
radio. CDP appears on the display when the CD player  
has been selected. The CD symbol will appear on the  
display when a CD is loaded.  
RDM (Random): Press the pushbutton below the RDM  
tab on the display to play tracks in random, rather than  
sequential order, RDM appears on the display. Press  
the pushbutton again to stop random play.  
Press CD/AUX while a CD is playing to pause the CD.  
PAUSE flashes on the display. Press CD/AUX again to  
start playing the CD.  
INT (Scan): Press the pushbutton below the INT tab on  
the display to listen to the first few seconds of each  
track on the CD, INTRO appears on the display. Press  
the pushbutton again to stop scanning and the current  
track begins to play.  
Press CD/AUX to play a CD when listening to the audio  
contents from other device (AUX mode). CDP appears  
on the display when the CD player has been selected.  
The CD symbol will appear on the display when a CD is  
loaded.  
Playing an MP3/WMA CD-R Disc  
The radio has the MP3/WMA CD-R disc capability. For  
more information, see Using an MP3 on page 461  
later in this section.  
EJECT: Press to eject a CD. The CD can be ejected  
when the ignition or the radio is turned off.  
INFO/DISP (Information/Display): Press to display  
additional text information related to the current  
MP3/WMA song. A choice of additional information  
such as: Song Title , Album Title, Artist, Bit rate may  
appear.  
4-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CD Messages  
Care of CDs  
CHECK CD: If this message displays and/or the CD  
comes out, it could be for one of the following reasons:  
If playing a CD-R, the sound quality can be reduced  
due to CD-R quality, the method of recording, the  
quality of the music that has been recorded, and the  
way the CD-R or CD-RW has been handled. Handle  
them carefully. Store CD-R(s) in their original cases or  
other protective cases and away from direct sunlight  
and dust. The CD player scans the bottom surface of  
the disc. If the surface of a CD is damaged, such as  
cracked, broken, or scratched, the CD does not play  
properly or not at all. Do not touch the bottom side of a  
CD while handling it; this could damage the surface.  
Pick up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of  
the hole and the outer edge.  
.
It is very hot. When the temperature returns to  
normal, the CD should play.  
.
The road is very rough. When the road becomes  
smoother, the CD should play.  
.
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.  
.
The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and  
try again.  
.
The format of the CD might not be compatible. See  
Using an MP3 on page 461 later in this section.  
.
There could have been a problem while burning  
the CD.  
If the surface of a CD is soiled, clean it with a soft, lint  
free cloth or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild,  
neutral detergent solution mixed with water. Make sure  
the wiping process starts from the center to the edge.  
.
The label could be caught in the CD player.  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason,  
try a known good CD.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer. If the radio  
displays an error message, write it down and provide it  
to your dealer/retailer when reporting the problem.  
4-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
Care of the CD Player  
Do not add labels to a CD, it could get caught in the CD  
player. Use a marking pen to write on the top of the CD  
if a description is needed.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input jack.  
When a device is connected, press the radio CD/AUX  
button to begin playing audio from the device over the  
vehicle speakers.  
Do not use CD lens cleaners, they could damage the  
CD player.  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than one  
CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an attempt  
is made to play scratched or damaged CDs, the CD  
player could be damaged. While using the CD  
player, use only CDs in good condition without any  
label, load one CD at a time, and keep the CD player  
and the loading slot free of foreign materials,  
liquids, and debris.  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume.  
Additional volume adjustments may have to be made  
from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or  
too loud.  
CD/AUX (Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while a  
portable audio device is playing. Press CD/AUX a  
second time for the system to begin playing audio from  
the connected portable audio player. The portable audio  
device continues playing until it is turned off.  
If an error displays, see CD Messagesearlier in this  
section.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system has a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input  
jack located on the lower right side of the faceplate.  
This is not an audio output; do not plug the headphone  
set into the front auxiliary input jack. An external audio  
device such as an iPod, laptop computer, MP3 player,  
CD changer, etc. can be connected to the 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) auxiliary input jack for use as another audio  
source.  
4-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Finding a Station  
Radio with Six-Disc CD  
BAND: Press to choose FM, AM, or XM™  
(if equipped). The display will show the selection.  
u SEEK: Press to seek the next radio station with a  
strong signal in the selected band.  
t SEEK: Press to seek the previous radio station with  
a strong signal in the selected band.  
[ TUNE: Press to go to the next station manually.  
r TUNE: Press to go to the previous station manually.  
SCAN/AST: Press to scan radio stations. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then goes to  
the next station. The radio only scans stations with a  
strong signal in the selected band. Press SCAN/AST  
again to stop scanning.  
Press and hold SCAN/AST to use Auto Store. The radio  
only scans stations with a strong signal in the  
selected band.  
Playing the Radio  
O (Power/Volume): Press and release to turn the  
system on. Press and hold this knob for more than  
two seconds to turn the system off.  
Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
When the system is on, press and release O to mute  
the system. Press and release O again to turn the  
sound back on.  
4-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AST (Automatic Store): Twelve preset stations with  
the strongest reception in the area can be automatically  
stored. The radio will only scan stations with a strong  
signal that are in the selected AM or FM band. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the FM band, only  
FM stations are stored in preset pages A1 and A2. If the  
Automatic Store function is started in the AM band, only  
AM stations are stored in A1 and A2. A combination of  
AM, FM and XM (if equipped) stations can be stored  
manually into the other four favorite pages.  
Automatic Store function is used, any stations that were  
previously set will be deleted and replaced with new  
stations.  
Storing a Radio Station  
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations  
using the pushbuttons, favorites button, and steering  
wheel controls. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
A maximum of 36 stations can be programmed as  
favorites using the six pushbuttons positioned below the  
radio station frequency labels and by using the radio  
favorites page button (FAV button). Press the FAV  
button to go through up to six pages of favorites, each  
having six favorite stations available per page.  
If Automatic Store is used, then four pages of favorites  
are available. Each page of favorites can contain any  
combination of AM, FM, or XM(if equipped) stations.  
To store a station as a favorite:  
To use Automatic Store:  
1. Press and hold SCAN/AST to use Auto  
Store mode.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the ON tab on the  
radio display.  
3. Automatic Store searches for radio stations with a  
strong signal and automatically set presets A1 and  
A2 with new stations.  
4. After all stations are set, press the pushbutton  
below the arrow tab on the radio display to return  
to the main radio screen  
1. Tune in the desired station.  
2. Press and release the FAV button to display the  
page where the station is to be stored.  
To reset the automatically stored radio stations, press  
and hold SCAN/AST. Then press the pushbutton below  
the RESE tab on the radio display. If no stations are  
stored on preset pages A1 and A2, the RESE option  
does not appear in the radio display. When the  
3. Press and hold one of the six numbered  
pushbuttons until a beep sounds. When the  
pushbutton is pressed and released, the station  
that was set will return.  
4. Repeat the Steps 1 through 3 for each radio  
station to be stored as a favorite.  
4-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To setup the number of favorites pages:  
Adjusting the Midrange  
To adjust the midrange:  
1. Press SOUND.  
1. Press and hold FAV until the radio setup menu  
displays.  
2. Select the desired number of favorites pages by  
pressing the pushbutton located below the  
displayed page numbers.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Mid tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press FAV to return to the original main radio  
screen showing the radio station frequency tabs  
and to begin the process of programming favorites  
for the chosen amount of numbered pages.  
Adjusting the Treble  
To adjust the treble:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Mid/Treble)  
SOUND (Bass/Mid/Treble): Press to adjust the bass,  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Treb tab on the  
display.  
midrange, or treble.  
Adjusting the Bass  
To adjust the bass:  
1. Press SOUND.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bass tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
Setting the EQ  
SOUND (Balance/Fade): Press to adjust the balance  
SOUND (Equalization): Press to select an equalization  
or fade.  
setting.  
Adjusting the Balance  
To adjust the balance:  
1. Press SOUND.  
Setting the EQ  
To set the EQ:  
1. Press SOUND.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Bal tab on the  
display.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the P.EQ tab on the  
display. The Pop, Rock, Ctry, Voice, Jazz, Clas  
tabs appear on the display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
3. Press the pushbutton below the desired selection  
to set the EQ. Pressing the same pushbutton again  
cancels the EQ setting.  
Adjusting the Fade  
To adjust the fade:  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
1. Press SOUND.  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety  
of programming and commercial-free music,  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or call  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
2. Press the pushbutton below the Fad tab on the  
display.  
3. Turn O to adjust the setting.  
4. The settings are saved after five seconds.  
4-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The CD player can play the smaller 8 cm (3 in) single  
CDs with an adapter ring. Full-size CDs and the smaller  
CDs are loaded in the same manner.  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
See XM Radio Messages on page 463 later in this  
section for further detail.  
To load a single CD into the CD player:  
Playing a CD(s)  
Loading a CD(s)  
1. Press the LOAD button, a message to select a slot  
number from 1 to 6 appears.  
2. Press the desired slot number. Wait for the  
message to insert the disc.  
The CD player can hold up to six CDs. As each CD is  
inserted, CDP will appear on the display and as each  
CD is loading. File check will appear on the display.  
Once playback begins, the track and track number will  
appear on the display.  
3. Load a CD. Insert the CD partway into the slot,  
label side up. The player will pull the CD in.  
To insert multiple CDs:  
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the  
player, it will stay in the player. When a CD is in the  
player and the ignition is in the ON/RUN position, the  
radio must be turned on before the CD will start playing.  
When the ignition and radio are turned on, the CD will  
start playing where it stopped, if it was the last selected  
audio source.  
1. Press and hold the LOAD button for two seconds.  
A beep sounds and a message to load multiple  
discs appears.  
2. Follow the displayed instruction on when to insert  
the discs. The CD player takes up to six CDs.  
3. Press the LOAD button again to cancel loading  
more CDs.  
4-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOAD: Press to load CDs into the CD player.  
Press CD/AUX to play a CD when listening to the audio  
contents from other device (AUX mode). CDC appears  
on the display when the CD player has been selected.  
The CD symbol will appear on the display when a CD is  
loaded.  
[ TUNE (Next Track): Press [ TUNE to go to the  
next track. The track number will appear on the display.  
The player will continue moving forward through the CD  
with each press of [ TUNE.  
EJECT: Press to eject a CD. Press and hold to eject all  
CDs. The CDs can be ejected when the ignition or the  
radio is turned off.  
r TUNE (Previous Track): Press to go to the start of  
the current track. The track number will appear on the  
display. The player will continue moving backward  
INFO/DISP (Information/Display): Press to display  
additional text information related to the current MP3/  
WMA song. A choice of additional information such as:  
Song Title , Album Title, Artist, Bit rate may appear.  
through the CD with each press of r TUNE.  
DSC (Previous CDC): Press to go back to the start of  
the previous CDC.  
RPT (Repeat): Press the pushbutton under the RPT tab  
on the display to repeat the current track, RPT appears  
on the display. Press the pushbutton again to stop  
repeat.  
DSC + (Next CDC): Press to go forward to the start of  
the next CDC.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a CD is  
playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
RDM (Random): Press the pushbutton below the RDM  
tab on the display to play tracks in random, rather than  
sequential order, RDM appears on the display. Press  
the pushbutton again to stop random play. To play  
tracks from all CDs loaded in the CD player in random  
order, press the pushbutton below the RDM tab until a  
message that all discs are randomized is displayed.  
Press the pushbutton again to stop random play.  
CD/AUX: Press to play a CD when listening to the  
radio. CDC appears on the display when the CD player  
has been selected. The CD symbol will appear on the  
display when a CD is loaded.  
Press CD/AUX while a CD is playing to pause the CD.  
PAUSE flashes on the display. Press CD/AUX again to  
start playing the CD.  
4-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INT (Scan): Press the pushbutton below the INT tab on  
the display to listen to the first few seconds of each  
track on each CD loaded, INTRO appears on the  
display. Press the pushbutton again to stop scanning  
and the current track begins to play.  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason,  
try a known good CD.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer. If the radio  
displays an error message, write it down and provide it  
to your dealer/retailer when reporting the problem.  
Playing an MP3/WMA CD-R Disc  
Care of CDs  
The radio has the MP3/WMA CD-R disc capability. For  
more information, see Using an MP3 on page 461  
later in this section.  
If playing a CD-R, the sound quality can be reduced  
due to CD-R quality, the method of recording, the  
quality of the music that has been recorded, and the  
way the CD-R or CD-RW has been handled. Handle  
them carefully. Store CD-R(s) in their original cases or  
other protective cases and away from direct sunlight  
and dust. The CD player scans the bottom surface of  
the disc. If the surface of a CD is damaged, such as  
cracked, broken, or scratched, the CD does not play  
properly or not at all. Do not touch the bottom side of a  
CD while handling it; this could damage the surface.  
Pick up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of  
the hole and the outer edge.  
CD Messages  
CHECK CD: If this message displays and/or the CD  
comes out, it could be for one of the following reasons:  
.
It is very hot. When the temperature returns to  
normal, the CD should play.  
.
The road is very rough. When the road becomes  
smoother, the CD should play.  
.
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.  
.
The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and  
try again.  
If the surface of a CD is soiled, clean it with a soft, lint  
free cloth or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild,  
neutral detergent solution mixed with water. Make sure  
the wiping process starts from the center to the edge.  
.
The format of the CD might not be compatible. See  
Using an MP3 on page 461 later in this section.  
.
There could have been a problem while burning  
the CD.  
.
The label could be caught in the CD player.  
4-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
Care of the CD Player  
Do not add labels to a CD, it could get caught in the CD  
player. Use a marking pen to write on the top of the CD  
if a description is needed.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input jack.  
When a device is connected, press the radio CD/AUX  
button to begin playing audio from the device over the  
vehicle speakers.  
Do not use CD lens cleaners, they could damage the  
CD player.  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than one  
CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an attempt  
is made to play scratched or damaged CDs, the CD  
player could be damaged. While using the CD  
player, use only CDs in good condition without any  
label, load one CD at a time, and keep the CD player  
and the loading slot free of foreign materials,  
liquids, and debris.  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume.  
Additional volume adjustments may have to be made  
from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or  
too loud.  
CD/AUX (Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while a  
portable audio device is playing. Press CD/AUX a  
second time for the system to begin playing audio from  
the connected portable audio player. The portable audio  
device continues playing until it is turned off.  
If an error displays, see CD Messagesearlier in this  
section.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system has a 3.5 mm (1/8 in) auxiliary input  
jack located on the lower right side of the faceplate.  
This is not an audio output; do not plug the headphone  
set into the front auxiliary input jack. An external audio  
device such as an iPod, laptop computer, MP3 player,  
CD changer, etc. can be connected to the 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) auxiliary input jack for use as another audio  
source.  
4-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
minimize the length of the file and folder names. An  
MP3/WMA CD that was recorded using no file folders  
can also be played. The system can support up to eight  
folders in depth, though, keep the depth of the folders to  
a minimum in order to keep down the complexity and  
confusion in trying to locate a particular folder during  
playback. If a CD contains more than the maximum of  
50 folders, five sessions, and 999 files, the player lets  
you access and navigate up to the maximum, but all  
items over the maximum are ignored.  
Using an MP3  
MP3/WMA CD-R Disc  
MP3 Format  
If you burn your own MP3/WMA disc on a personal  
computer:  
.
Make sure the MP3/WMA files are recorded on a  
CD-R disc.  
.
Do not mix standard audio and MP3/WMA files on  
Root Directory  
one disc.  
The root directory is treated as a folder. If the root  
directory has compressed audio files, the directory is  
displayed as ROOT. All files contained directly under  
the root directory are accessed prior to any other  
directory.  
.
Make sure each MP3/WMA file has a .m3u or  
.wma extension, other file extensions might  
not work.  
.
Files can be recorded with a variety of fixed or  
variable bit rates. Song title, artist name, and  
album are available for display by the radio when  
recorded using ID3 tags version 1 and 2.  
Empty Directory or Folder  
If a root directory or a folder exists somewhere in the  
file structure that contains only folders/subfolders and  
no compressed files directly beneath them, the player  
advances to the next folder in the file structure that  
contains compressed audio files. The empty folder does  
not display.  
.
Make sure to finalize the disc when burning an  
MP3/WMA disc, using multiple sessions. It is  
usually better to burn the disc all at once.  
The player is able to read and play a maximum of  
50 folders, five sessions, and 999 files. Long file names  
and folder names can use more disc memory space  
than necessary. To conserve space on the disc,  
4-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
No Folder  
Playing an MP3/WMA  
When a CD contains only compressed files, the files are  
located under the root folder. The next and previous  
folder function does not function on a CD that was  
recorded without folders or playlists. When displaying  
the name of the folder the radio displays ROOT.  
With the ignition in the ON/RUN position, insert a CD  
partway into the slot, label side up. The player pulls the  
disc in. The CD should begin playing. As each new  
track starts to play, the track number, and the song  
name will appear on the display. If the ignition or radio  
is turned off with a CD in the player, it will stay in the  
player. When a CD is in the player and the ignition is  
turned on, the radio must be turned on before the CD  
will start playback. When the ignition and radio are  
turned on, the CD will start playing where it stopped, if it  
was the last selected audio source.  
When a CD contains only compressed audio files, but  
no folders, all files are located under the root folder.  
When the radio displays the name of the folder, the  
radio displays ROOT.  
Order of Play  
The CD player can play the smaller 8 cm (3 in) single  
CDs with an adapter ring. Full-size CDs and the smaller  
CDs are loaded in the same manner.  
The player play will begin from the first track under the  
root directory. When all tracks from the root directory  
have been played, play will continue from files  
according to their numerical listing. After playing the last  
track from the last folder, the player will begin playing  
again at the first track of the first folder or root directory.  
Sound quality may be reduced due to CD-R quality, the  
method of recording, the quality of the music that has  
been recorded, and the way the CD-R has been  
handled.  
File System and Naming  
DIR (Directory): Press to repeat the tracks in the  
current directory. DIR displays.  
The song name in the ID3 tag is displayed. If the song  
name is not present in the ID3 tag, then the radio  
displays the file name without the extension (such as  
MP3/WMA) instead.  
Press DIR again to repeat the tracks in all of the  
directories. ALL displays.  
Press DIR again to turn off repeat play.  
Track names longer than 32 characters or four pages  
are shortened. Parts of words on the last page of text  
and the extension of the filename does not display.  
4-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
u SEEK t (Next/Previous Folder) (in MP3/WMA  
Mode): Press to change the folder. If CD-R does not  
have any folders, ROOTflashes on the display for a  
short time.  
XM Radio Messages  
UPDATING: The encryption code in the receiver is  
being updated, and no action is required. This process  
should take no longer than 30 seconds.  
[ TUNE (Next Track): Press the up TUNE arrow to go  
to the next track. The track number displays. The player  
continues moving forward through the CD each time  
TUNE is pressed.  
NO SIGNAL: The system is functioning correctly, but  
the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM™  
signal. When the vehicle is moved into an open area,  
the signal should return.  
r TUNE (Previous Track): Press the down TUNE  
arrow to go to the start of the current track. The track  
number displays. The player continues moving  
LOADING: The audio system is acquiring and  
processing audio and text data. No action is needed.  
This message should disappear shortly.  
backward through the CD each time TUNE is pressed.  
OFF AIR: This channel is not currently in service. Tune  
in to another channel.  
INFO/DISP (Information/Display): Press to display  
additional text information related to the current MP3/  
WMA song. A choice of additional information such as:  
Song Title, Album Title, and Artist. Bit rate might also  
display.  
CH UNAVAILABLE: This previously assigned channel  
is no longer assigned. Tune to another station. If this  
station was one of the presets, choose another station  
for that preset button.  
When information is not available, No Info displays.  
RADIO ID: If tuned to channel 0, this message  
alternates with the XMRadio 8 digit radio ID label.  
This label is needed to activate the service.  
Press this button for longer than two seconds to change  
display mode.  
SCROLL (MP3/WMA Mode Only): Press the SOUND  
button for longer than two seconds. The song title or  
other available information of a song scrolls on/off. The  
offset is scroll on. The scroll mode can be changed only  
when the SOUND button is pressed for longer than  
two seconds.  
CHECK XM TUNER: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
4-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
+ VOLUME : Press the toggle bar located below the  
+ VOLUME to adjust the volume. Press the left side of  
the toggle bar, below the + (plus) sign to increase the  
volume. Press the right side of the toggle bar, below the  
(minus) sign to decrease the volume.  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
MODE: Press and release this button multiple times to  
cycle through the audio playback options that are  
available on the vehicle. Options may include FM, AM,  
XM, CD, and AUX.  
SEEK: Press and release to go to the next preset  
station.  
Press and hold for a long time to go to the next AM, FM,  
or XM station. The radio seeks stations only with a  
strong signal that are in the selected band.  
Front View of the Steering Side View of the Volume  
Wheel Controls  
Control  
When playing a CD, press and release to go to the next  
track. Press and hold to fast forward through the tracks.  
If the vehicle has this feature, some audio controls can  
be adjusted at the steering wheel.  
PWR (Power): Press and release to turn the system on  
and off.  
When the system is on, press and release for a short  
time to mute the system. Press and release again to  
turn the sound back on.  
4-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
Radio Reception  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception  
from coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous United States,  
and in Canada. Just as with FM, tall buildings or hills  
can interfere with satellite radio signals, causing the  
sound to fade in and out. In addition, traveling or  
standing under heavy foliage, bridges, garages,  
or tunnels may cause loss of the XM signal for a period  
of time.  
Frequency interference and static can occur during  
normal radio reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience accessories, and  
external electronic devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is interference or static,  
unplug the item from the accessory power outlet.  
AM  
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM,  
especially at night. The longer range can cause station  
frequencies to interfere with each other. For better radio  
reception, most AM radio stations boost the power  
levels during the day, and then reduce these levels  
during the night. Static can also occur when things like  
storms and power lines interfere with radio reception.  
When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio.  
Cellular Phone Usage  
Cellular phone usage may cause interference with the  
vehicle's radio. This interference may occur when  
making or receiving phone calls, charging the phone's  
battery, or simply having the phone on. This  
interference causes an increased level of static while  
listening to the radio. If static is received while listening  
to the radio, unplug the cellular phone and turn it off.  
FM Stereo  
Fixed Mast Antenna (Hatchback)  
FM signals only reach about 10 to 40 miles (16 to 65 km).  
Although the radio has a built-in electronic circuit that  
automatically works to reduce interference, some static  
can occur, especially around tall buildings or hills,  
causing the sound to fade in and out.  
Vehicles without OnStar® have a fixed mast antenna  
that can withstand most car washes without being  
damaged. If the mast should ever become slightly bent,  
straighten it out by hand. If the mast is badly bent,  
replace it.  
Check occasionally to make sure the mast is still  
tightened to the antenna base located on the roof of the  
vehicle. If tightening is required, tighten by hand.  
4-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If static is heard on the radio, when the rear window  
defogger is turned on, it could mean that a defogger  
grid line has been damaged. If this is true, the grid line  
must be repaired.  
Backglass Antenna (Sedan)  
Vehicles without OnStar® have the AM-FM antenna  
integrated with the rear window defogger, located in the  
rear window. Make sure that the inside surface of the  
rear window is not scratched and that the lines on the  
glass are not damaged. If the inside surface is  
damaged, it could interfere with radio reception. Also,  
for proper radio reception, the antenna connector at the  
top-center of the rear window needs to be properly  
attached to the post on the glass.  
If adding a cellular telephone to the vehicle, and the  
antenna needs to be attached to the glass, make sure  
that the grid lines for the AM-FM antenna are not  
damaged. There is enough space between the grid  
lines to attach a cellular telephone antenna without  
interfering with radio reception.  
Notice: Using a razor blade or sharp object to clear  
the inside rear window can damage the rear window  
antenna and/or the rear window defogger. Repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do  
not clear the inside rear window with sharp objects.  
Multi-Band Antenna  
Vehicles with OnStar® have a multi-band antenna that is  
located on the roof of the vehicle. The antenna is used  
for the AM/FM radio, OnStar® and the XMSatellite  
Radio Service System. Keep the antenna clear of  
obstructions for clear reception. If the vehicle has a  
sunroof, the performance of the AM/FM radio, OnStar®,  
and the XM system may be affected if the sunroof  
is open.  
Notice: Do not apply aftermarket glass tinting with  
metallic film. The metallic film in some tinting  
materials will interfere with or distort the incoming  
radio reception. Any damage caused to your  
backglass antenna due to metallic tinting materials  
will not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Because this antenna is built into the rear window, there  
is a reduced risk of damage caused by car washes and  
vandals.  
4-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5 Driving Your Vehicle  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice,  
or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Loading the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8  
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Towing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drunk Driving  
Your Driving, the Road, and the  
Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
Defensive Driving  
Drinking and then driving is very dangerous. Your  
reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and judgment  
can be affected by even a small amount of  
alcohol. You can have a serious or even  
fatal collision if you drive after drinking. Do not  
drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if you are with a  
group, designate a driver who will not drink.  
Defensive driving means always expect the  
unexpected.The first step in driving defensively is to  
wear your safety belt See Safety Belts: They Are for  
Everyone on page 214.  
WARNING:  
{
Assume that other road users (pedestrians,  
bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be  
careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what they  
might do and be ready. In addition:  
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is  
a global tragedy.  
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a  
vehicle: judgment, muscular coordination, vision, and  
attentiveness.  
.
Allow enough following distance between you  
and the driver in front of you.  
.
Focus on the task of driving.  
Police records show that almost 40 percent of all motor  
vehicle-related deaths involve alcohol. In most cases,  
these deaths are the result of someone who was  
drinking and driving. In recent years, more than  
17,000 annual motor vehicle-related deaths have been  
associated with the use of alcohol, with about  
250,000 people injured.  
Driver distraction can cause collisions resulting in  
injury or possible death. These simple defensive  
driving techniques could save your life.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For persons under 21, it is against the law in every U.S.  
state to drink alcohol. There are good medical,  
psychological, and developmental reasons for  
these laws.  
Braking  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 428.  
Braking action involves perception time and reaction  
time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception  
time. Actually doing it is reaction time.  
The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway  
safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol and  
then drive.  
Average reaction time is about threefourths of a  
second. But that is only an average. It might be less  
with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or  
more with another. Age, physical condition, alertness,  
coordination, and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol,  
drugs, and frustration. But even in threefourths of a  
second, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels  
20 m (66 feet). That could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough space between the  
vehicle and others is important.  
Medical research shows that alcohol in a person's  
system can make crash injuries worse, especially  
injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or heart. This means  
that when anyone who has been drinking driver or  
passenger is in a crash, that person's chance of  
being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if the  
person had not been drinking.  
Control of a Vehicle  
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly  
with the surface of the road, whether it is pavement or  
gravel; the condition of the road, whether it is wet, dry,  
or icy; tire tread; the condition of the brakes; the weight  
of the vehicle; and the amount of brake force applied.  
The following three systems help to control the vehicle  
while driving brakes, steering, and accelerator. At  
times, as when driving on snow or ice, it is easy to ask  
more of those control systems than the tires and road  
can provide. Meaning, you can lose control of the  
vehicle.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64.  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in  
spurts, heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking,  
rather than keeping pace with traffic. This is a mistake.  
The brakes might not have time to cool between hard  
stops. The brakes will wear out much faster with a lot of  
heavy braking. Keeping pace with the traffic and  
allowing realistic following distances eliminates a lot of  
unnecessary braking. That means better braking and  
longer brake life.  
If the vehicle has ABS,  
this warning light comes  
on briefly when the  
vehicle is started.  
The warning light is on the instrument panel cluster.  
See Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light on  
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is being  
driven, brake normally but do not pump the brakes.  
If the brakes are pumped, the pedal could get harder to  
push down. If the engine stops, there will still be some  
power brake assist but it will be used when the brake is  
applied. Once the power assist is used up, it can take  
longer to stop and the brake pedal will be harder  
to push.  
page 429  
.
Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely.  
Suddenly, an animal jumps out in front of you. You slam  
on the brakes and continue braking. Here is what  
happens with ABS:  
A computer senses that the wheels are slowing down.  
If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work the brakes at each wheel.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 64.  
ABS can change the brake pressure to each wheel, as  
required, faster than any driver could. This can help the  
driver steer around the obstacle while braking hard.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
The vehicle might have the Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), an advanced electronic braking system that  
helps prevent a braking skid.  
As the brakes are applied, the computer keeps  
receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking  
pressure accordingly.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remember: ABS does not change the time needed to  
get a foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease  
stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle in  
front of you, there will not be enough time to apply the  
brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always  
leave enough room up ahead to stop, even with ABS.  
If the vehicle does not have ABS, use a squeeze”  
braking technique. This gives maximum braking while  
maintaining steering control. Do this by pushing on the  
brake pedal with steadily increasing pressure.  
In an emergency, you will probably want to squeeze the  
brakes hard without locking the wheels. If you hear or  
feel the wheels sliding, ease off the brake pedal. This  
helps retain steering control. With ABS, it is different.  
See Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54.  
Using ABS  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal  
down firmly and let antilock work. A slight brake pedal  
pulsation might be felt or some noise might be heard,  
but this is normal.  
In many emergencies, steering can help more than  
even the very best braking.  
Steering  
Braking in Emergencies  
Power Steering  
If power steering assist is lost because the engine stops  
or the system is not functioning, the vehicle can be  
steered but it will take more effort.  
At some time, nearly every driver gets into a situation  
that requires hard braking.  
If the vehicle has ABS, it allows the driver to steer and  
brake at the same time. However, if the vehicle does  
not have ABS, the first reaction to hit the brake pedal  
hard and hold it down might be the wrong thing to do.  
The wheels can stop rolling. Once they do, the vehicle  
cannot respond to the driver's steering. Momentum will  
carry it in whatever direction it was headed when the  
wheels stopped rolling. That could be off the road, into  
the very thing the driver was trying to avoid, or into  
traffic.  
Steering Tips  
It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the condition of the tires  
and the road surface, the angle at which the curve is  
banked, and vehicle speed. While in a curve, speed is  
the one factor that can be controlled.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If there is a need to reduce speed, do it before entering  
the curve, while the front wheels are straight.  
Try to adjust the speed so you can drive through the  
curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve, and then accelerate  
gently into the straightaway.  
Steering in Emergencies  
There are times when steering can be more effective  
than braking. For example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane, or a car suddenly pulls  
out from nowhere, or a child darts out from between  
parked cars and stops right in front of you. These  
problems can be avoided by braking if you can stop  
in time. But sometimes you cannot stop in time because  
there is no room. That is the time for evasive  
An emergency like this requires close attention and a  
quick decision. If holding the steering wheel at the  
recommended 9 and 3 o'clock positions, it can be  
turned a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing  
either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and  
just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have  
avoided the object.  
action steering around the problem.  
The vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like  
these. First apply the brakes but, unless the vehicle  
has antilock brakes, not enough to lock the wheels. See  
Braking on page 53. It is better to remove as much  
speed as possible from a collision. Then steer around  
the problem, to the left or right depending on the space  
available.  
The fact that such emergency situations are always  
possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving  
at all times and wear safety belts properly.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Road Recovery  
Passing  
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a  
road onto the shoulder while driving.  
Passing another vehicle on a two-lane road can be  
dangerous. To reduce the risk of danger while passing:  
.
Look down the road, to the sides, and to  
crossroads for situations that might affect a  
successful pass. If in doubt, wait.  
.
Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings, and  
lines that could indicate a turn or an intersection.  
Never cross a solid or doublesolid line on your  
side of the lane.  
.
Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to  
pass. Doing so can reduce your visibility.  
.
Wait your turn to pass a slow vehicle.  
.
When you are being passed, ease to the right.  
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the  
pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the  
accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer  
so that the vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement.  
Turn the steering wheel 8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches),  
about one-eighth turn, until the right front tire contacts  
the pavement edge. Then turn the steering wheel to go  
straight down the roadway.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice,  
gravel, or other material is on the road. For safety, slow  
down and adjust your driving to these conditions. It is  
important to slow down on slippery surfaces because  
stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control  
more limited.  
Loss of Control  
Let us review what driving experts say about what  
happens when the three control systems brakes,  
steering, and acceleration do not have enough  
friction where the tires meet the road to do what the  
driver has asked.  
While driving on a surface with reduced traction, try  
your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting  
to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the  
tires to slide. You may not realize the surface is slippery  
until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning  
clues such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on  
the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down  
when you have any doubt.  
In any emergency, do not give up. Keep trying to steer  
and constantly seek an escape route or area of less  
danger.  
Skidding  
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle.  
Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking  
reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and by  
not overdriving those conditions. But skids are always  
possible.  
If the vehicle has the Antilock Brake System (ABS),  
remember: It helps avoid only the braking skid. If the  
vehicle does not have ABS, then in a braking skid,  
where the wheels are no longer rolling, release enough  
pressure on the brakes to get the wheels rolling again.  
This restores steering control. Push the brake pedal  
down steadily when you have to stop suddenly. As long  
as the wheels are rolling, you will have steering control.  
The three types of skids correspond to the vehicle's  
three control systems. In the braking skid, the wheels  
are not rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too  
much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip  
and lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid,  
too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough,  
the vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a  
second skid if it occurs.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving at Night  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads  
Night driving is more dangerous than day driving  
because some drivers are likely to be impaired by  
alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by  
fatigue.  
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and  
affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive  
slower in these types of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and deepstanding or  
flowing water.  
Night driving tips include:  
.
Drive defensively.  
WARNING:  
.
{
Do not drink and drive.  
.
Reduce headlamp glare by adjusting the inside  
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not  
work as well in a quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could lose control of the  
vehicle.  
rearview mirror.  
.
Slow down and keep more space between you and  
other vehicles because headlamps can only light  
up so much road ahead.  
.
After driving through a large puddle of water or a  
car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal  
until the brakes work normally.  
Watch for animals.  
.
When tired, pull off the road.  
.
Do not wear sunglasses.  
Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces.  
Driving through flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you  
and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be very cautious about  
trying to drive through flowing water.  
.
Avoid staring directly into approaching headlamps.  
.
Keep the windshield and all glass on your vehicle  
clean inside and out.  
.
Keep your eyes moving, especially during turns or  
curves.  
No one can see as well at night as in the daytime.  
But, as we get older, these differences increase.  
A 50-year-old driver might need at least twice as much  
light to see the same thing at night as a 20-year-old.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Things to check on your own include:  
Hydroplaning  
.
Windshield Washer Fluid: Reservoir full? Windows  
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under  
your vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water.  
This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are  
going fast enough. When your vehicle is hydroplaning, it  
has little or no contact with the road.  
clean inside and outside?  
.
Wiper Blades: In good shape?  
.
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All levels checked?  
.
Lamps: Do they all work and are lenses clean?  
There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The  
best advice is to slow down when the road is wet.  
.
Tires: Are treads good? Are tires inflated to  
recommended pressure?  
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips  
include:  
.
Weather and Maps: Safe to travel? Have  
up-to-date maps?  
Highway Hypnosis  
.
Allow extra following distance.  
.
.
.
.
Always be alert and pay attention to your surroundings  
while driving. If you become tired or sleepy, find a safe  
place to park your vehicle and rest.  
Pass with caution.  
Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape.  
Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled.  
Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires  
Other driving tips include:  
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
on page 651  
.
.
Keep interior temperature cool.  
.
Turn off cruise control.  
.
Keep your eyes moving scan the road ahead  
and to the sides.  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip  
To prepare your vehicle for a long trip, consider having  
it serviced by your dealer/retailer before departing.  
.
Check the rearview mirror and vehicle instruments  
often.  
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different  
than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for driving in  
these conditions include:  
WARNING:  
{
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the  
ignition off is dangerous. The brakes will have to  
do all the work of slowing down and they could  
get so hot that they would not work well. You  
would then have poor braking or even none going  
down a hill. You could crash. Always have the  
engine running and the vehicle in gear when  
going downhill.  
.
Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape.  
.
Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling  
system, and transmission.  
.
Going down steep or long hills, shift to a  
lower gear.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not swing wide or cut  
across the center of the road. Drive at speeds that  
let you stay in your own lane.  
If you do not shift down, the brakes could get so  
hot that they would not work well. You would then  
have poor braking or even none going down a hill.  
You could crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope.  
.
.
Top of hills: Be alert something could be in your  
lane (stalled car, accident).  
Pay attention to special road signs (falling rocks  
area, winding roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take appropriate action.  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Allow greater following distance on any slippery road  
and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur on  
otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface of a  
curve or an overpass can remain icy when the  
surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while on ice.  
Winter Driving  
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Drive carefully when there is snow or ice between the  
tires and the road, creating less traction or grip. Wet ice  
can occur at about 0°C (32°F) when freezing rain  
begins to fall, resulting in even less traction. Avoid  
driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped, on slippery surfaces.  
Blizzard Conditions  
Being stuck in snow can be in a serious situation. Stay  
with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible,  
Drive with caution, whatever the condition. Accelerate  
gently so traction is not lost. Accelerating too quickly  
causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under  
the tires slick, so there is even less traction.  
use the Roadside Assistance Program on page 87  
.
To get help and keep everyone in the vehicle safe:  
.
Turn on the Hazard Warning Flashers on  
Try not to break the fragile traction. If you accelerate too  
fast, the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface  
under the tires even more.  
page 43  
.
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.  
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54  
improves vehicle stability during hard stops on slippery  
roads, but whether the vehicle has ABS or not, apply  
the brakes sooner than when on dry pavement. Without  
ABS, if the vehicle begins to slide, let up on the brake  
pedal a little and apply steady pedal pressure to get the  
most traction. On vehicles without ABS, braking so hard  
that the wheels stop rolling can cause the vehicle to  
slide brake so the wheels always keep rolling so you  
can still steer.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle.  
This may cause exhaust gases to get inside.  
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 332.  
Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle.  
This can cause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas  
to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill you.  
You cannot see it or smell it, so you might not  
know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from  
around the base of your vehicle, especially any  
that is blocking the exhaust.  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
.
Clear away snow from around the base of  
your vehicle, especially any that is blocking  
the exhaust pipe.  
.
Check again from time to time to be sure  
Run the engine for short periods only as needed to  
keep warm, but be careful.  
snow does not collect there.  
.
Open a window about 5 cm (two inches) on  
the side of the vehicle that is away from the  
wind to bring in fresh air.  
To save fuel, run the engine for only short periods as  
needed to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine  
off and close the window most of the way to save heat.  
Repeat this until help arrives but only when you feel  
really uncomfortable from the cold. Moving about to  
keep warm also helps.  
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
If it takes some time for help to arrive, now and then  
when you run the engine, push the accelerator pedal  
slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed.  
This keeps the battery charged to restart the vehicle  
and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as  
little as possible to save fuel.  
that circulates the air inside the vehicle and  
set the fan speed to the highest setting. See  
Climate Control System in the Index.  
(Continued)  
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow  
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the  
vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 514.  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out  
Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area  
around the front wheels. Shift back and forth between  
R (Reverse) and a forward gear, or with a manual  
transmission, between 1 (First) or 2 (Second) and  
R (Reverse), spinning the wheels as little as possible.  
To prevent transmission wear, wait until the wheels stop  
spinning before shifting gears. Release the accelerator  
pedal while shifting, and press lightly on the accelerator  
pedal when the transmission is in gear. Slowly spinning  
the wheels in the forward and reverse directions causes  
a rocking motion that could free the vehicle. If that does  
not get the vehicle out after a few tries, it might need to  
be towed out. If the vehicle does need to be towed out,  
see Towing Your Vehicle on page 521.  
WARNING:  
{
If you let your vehicle's tires spin at high speed,  
they can explode, and you or others could be  
injured. The vehicle can overheat, causing an  
engine compartment fire or other damage. Spin  
the wheels as little as possible and avoid going  
above 55 km/h (35 mph) as shown on the  
speedometer.  
For information about using tire chains on the vehicle,  
see Tire Chains on page 669.  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire and Loading Information Label  
Loading the Vehicle  
It is very important to know how much weight your  
vehicle can carry. This weight is called the vehicle  
capacity weight or maximum load amount and  
includes the weight of all occupants, cargo, and  
all nonfactoryinstalled options. Two labels on  
your vehicle show how much weight it may  
properly carry, the Tire and Loading Information  
label and the Certification label.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to the vehicle's center  
pillar (Bpillar). With the driver's door open, you  
will find the label attached below the door lock  
post (striker). The Tire and Loading Information  
label shows the number of occupant seating  
positions (A), and the maximum vehicle capacity  
weight (B) in kilograms and pounds.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Tire and Loading Information label also  
shows the tire size of the original equipment  
tires (C) and the recommended cold tire inflation  
pressures (D). For more information on tires and  
inflation see Tires on page 651 and Inflation - Tire  
4. The resulting figure equals the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.  
For example, if the XXXamount equals  
1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb  
passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is  
650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
Pressure on page 658  
.
There is also important loading information on the  
Certification label. See Certification Labellater in  
this section.  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage  
and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That  
weight may not safely exceed the available  
cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in  
Step 4.  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit  
1. Locate the statement The combined weight  
of occupants and cargo should never exceed  
XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load  
from your trailer will be transferred to your  
vehicle. Consult this manual to determine  
how this reduces the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers that will be riding in your  
vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
Your vehicle is neither designed nor intended to  
tow a trailer.  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example 1  
Description  
Example 2  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 1 =  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 2 =  
A
A
(453 kg)  
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 2 =  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 5 =  
B
C
300 lbs (136 kg)  
700 lbs (317 kg)  
B
C
750 lbs (340 kg)  
250 lbs (113 kg)  
Available Occupant  
and Cargo Weight =  
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Refer to your vehicle's tire and loading information  
label for specific information about your vehicle's  
capacity weight and seating positions. The  
combined weight of the driver, passenger, and  
cargo should never exceed your vehicle's capacity  
weight.  
Example 3  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Vehicle Capacity  
Weight for  
Example 3 =  
A
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 200 lbs  
(91 kg) × 5 =  
1,000 lbs  
(453 kg)  
B
C
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
0 lbs (0 kg)  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Certification Label  
Label Example Canada  
A vehicle specific Certification label is attached to  
the center pillar (Bpillar), below the driver's door  
latch. This label tells you the gross weight  
capacity of your vehicle, called the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR). The GVWR includes the  
weight of the vehicle, all occupants, fuel and  
cargo. Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle,  
or the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for  
either the front or rear axle.  
Label Example United States  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If there is a heavy load, it should be spread out.  
See Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit”  
earlier in this section.  
WARNING:  
{
Things you put inside your vehicle can strike  
and injure people in a sudden stop or turn,  
or in a crash.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Put things in the cargo area of your  
vehicle. Try to spread the weight evenly.  
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
.
Never stack heavier things, like  
suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some  
of them are above the tops of the seats.  
.
Do not leave an unsecured child restraint  
in your vehicle.  
.
When you carry something inside the  
vehicle, secure it whenever you can.  
Notice : Overloading the vehicle may cause  
damage. Repairs would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle.  
.
Do not leave a seat folded down unless  
you need to.  
If you put things inside your vehicle like  
suitcases, tools, packages, or anything  
else they will go as fast as the vehicle goes.  
If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there is a  
crash, they will keep going.  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are some important things to consider before  
recreational vehicle towing:  
Towing  
.
What is the towing capacity of the towing vehicle?  
Towing Your Vehicle  
Be sure to read the tow vehicle manufacturer's  
recommendations.  
To avoid damage, the disabled vehicle should be towed  
with all four wheels off the ground. Consult your dealer/  
retailer or a professional towing service if the disabled  
vehicle must be towed. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 87.  
.
What is the distance that will be travelled? Some  
vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long  
they can tow.  
.
Is the proper towing equipment going to be used?  
To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle for  
recreational purposes, such as behind a motorhome,  
see Recreational Vehicle Towingfollowing.  
See your dealer/retailer or trailering professional  
for additional advice and equipment  
recommendations.  
.
Is the vehicle ready to be towed? Just as preparing  
Recreational Vehicle Towing  
the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is  
prepared to be towed. See Before Leaving on a  
Long Trip on page 510.  
Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle  
behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome.  
The two most common types of recreational vehicle  
towing are known as dinghy towing and dolly towing.  
Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels  
on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with  
two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a  
device known as a dolly.  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dinghy Towing  
Dolly Towing From the Front  
The vehicle can be towed from the front using a dolly.  
To tow the vehicle using a dolly, follow these steps:  
Notice: If the vehicle is towed with all four wheels  
on the ground, the drivetrain components could be  
damaged. The repairs would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Do not tow the vehicle with all four  
wheels on the ground.  
1. Attach the dolly to the tow vehicle following the  
dolly manufacturer's instructions.  
2. Drive the front wheels onto the dolly.  
The vehicle was not designed to be towed with all four  
wheels on the ground. If the vehicle must be towed, a  
dolly should be used. See Dolly Towingthat follows for  
more information.  
3. Put an automatic transmission in P (Park) or a  
manual transmission in N (Neutral).  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Set the parking brake and remove the key.  
Dolly Towing From the Rear  
5. For an automatic transmission, insert the key into  
the shiftlock release slot and shift to N (Neutral).  
See Shifting Out of Park on page 330.  
6. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead  
position with a clamping device designed for  
towing.  
7. Release the parking brake.  
Notice: Towing the vehicle from the rear with  
the front wheels on the ground could cause  
transmission damage. Do not tow the vehicle from  
the rear with the front wheels on the ground.  
Towing a Trailer  
The vehicle is neither designed nor intended to tow a  
trailer.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20  
Manual Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-30  
Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Windshield Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Proposition 65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44  
Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker and Parking  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL)  
(Hatchback) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL)  
(Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-47  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Sidemarker, Stoplamps  
and Back-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-51  
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Tire Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-62  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-79  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-79  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Aluminum Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . . . 6-87  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories and Modifications  
Service  
When nondealer/nonretailer accessories are added to  
the vehicle, they can affect vehicle performance and  
safety, including such things as airbags, braking,  
stability, ride and handling, emissions systems,  
aerodynamics, durability, and electronic systems like  
antilock brakes, traction control, and stability control.  
Some of these accessories could even cause  
malfunction or damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
For service and parts needs, visit your dealer/retailer.  
You will receive genuine GM parts and GM-trained and  
supported service people.  
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:  
Damage to vehicle components resulting from the  
installation or use of nonGM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, is not covered under the  
terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining  
warranty coverage for affected parts.  
GM Accessories are designed to complement and  
function with other systems on the vehicle. Your GM  
dealer/retailer can accessorize the vehicle using  
genuine GM Accessories. When you go to your GM  
dealer/retailer and ask for GM Accessories, you  
will know that GM-trained and supported service  
technicians will perform the work using genuine GM  
Accessories.  
Also, see Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 271.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
California Proposition 65 Warning  
Doing Your Own Service Work  
WARNING:  
Most motor vehicles, including this one, contain and/or  
emit chemicals known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive  
harm. Engine exhaust, many parts and systems, many  
fluids, and some component wear by-products contain  
and/or emit these chemicals.  
{
You can be injured and the vehicle could be  
damaged if you try to do service work on a vehicle  
without knowing enough about it.  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements  
Certain types of automotive applications, such as  
airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium  
batteries contained in remote keyless transmitters,  
may contain perchlorate materials. Special handling  
may be necessary. For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
.
Be sure you have sufficient knowledge,  
experience, the proper replacement parts,  
and tools before attempting any vehicle  
maintenance task.  
.
Be sure to use the proper nuts, bolts, and  
other fasteners. English and metric fasteners  
can be easily confused. If the wrong fasteners  
are used, parts can later break or fall off. You  
could be hurt.  
If doing some of your own service work, use the proper  
service manual. It tells you much more about how to  
service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the  
proper service manual, see Service Publications  
Ordering Information on page 817.  
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting  
to do your own service work, see Servicing Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 270.  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the  
mileage and the date of any service work performed.  
See Maintenance Record on page 715.  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of  
the Vehicle  
Things added to the outside of the vehicle can affect  
the airflow around it. This can cause wind noise and  
can affect fuel economy and windshield washer  
performance. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding equipment to the outside of the vehicle.  
Fuel  
Use of the recommended fuel is an important part of  
the proper maintenance of this vehicle. To help keep  
the engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle  
performance, we recommend the use of gasoline  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
Gasoline Octane  
Look for the TOP TIER label on the fuel pump to  
ensure gasoline meets enhanced detergency standards  
developed by auto companies. A list of marketers  
providing TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found  
at www.toptiergas.com.  
Use regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane  
rating of 87 or higher. If the octane rating is less than  
87, an audible knocking noise, commonly referred to  
as spark knock, might be heard when driving. If this  
occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher  
as soon as possible. If heavy knocking is heard when  
using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine  
needs service.  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gasoline Specifications  
Additives  
At a minimum, gasoline should meet ASTM  
specification D 4814 in the United States or  
CAN/CGSB3.5 or 3.511 in Canada. Some gasolines  
contain an octane-enhancing additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).  
We recommend against the use of gasolines containing  
MMT. See Additives on page 67 for additional  
information.  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States  
are now required to contain additives that help prevent  
engine and fuel system deposits from forming, allowing  
the emission control system to work properly. In most  
cases, nothing should have to be added to the fuel.  
However, some gasolines contain only the minimum  
amount of additive required to meet U.S. Environmental  
Protection Agency regulations. To help keep fuel  
injectors and intake valves clean, or if the vehicle  
experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves,  
look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline.  
California Fuel  
If the vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions  
Standards, it is designed to operate on fuels that meet  
California specifications. See the underhood emission  
control label. If this fuel is not available in states  
adopting California emissions standards, the vehicle  
will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  
specifications, but emission control system performance  
might be affected. The malfunction indicator lamp could  
turn on and the vehicle might fail a smogcheck test.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 431. If this  
occurs, return to your authorized dealer/retailer for  
diagnosis. If it is determined that the condition is caused  
by the type of fuel used, repairs might not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
For customers who do not use TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline regularly, one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel tank at every engine  
oil change, can help clean deposits from fuel injectors  
and intake valves. GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS is  
the only gasoline additive recommended by General  
Motors.  
Also, your dealer/retailer has additives that will help  
correct and prevent most depositrelated problems.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gasolines containing oxygenates, such as ethers and  
ethanol, and reformulated gasolines might be available  
in your area. We recommend that you use these  
gasolines, if they comply with the specifications  
described earlier. However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more than 10% ethanol must not  
be used in vehicles that were not designed for those  
fuels.  
Fuels in Foreign Countries  
If you plan on driving in another country outside the  
United States or Canada, the proper fuel might be hard  
to find. Never use leaded gasoline or any other fuel  
not recommended in the previous text on fuel. Costly  
repairs caused by use of improper fuel would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
To check the fuel availability, ask an auto club,  
or contact a major oil company that does business in  
the country where you will be driving.  
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that  
contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing  
methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic and rubber parts.  
That damage would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
Filling the Tank  
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low  
emissions can contain an octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl  
(MMT); ask the attendant where you buy gasoline  
whether the fuel contains MMT. We recommend against  
the use of such gasolines. Fuels containing MMT can  
reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance of  
the emission control system could be affected. The  
malfunction indicator lamp might turn on. If this occurs,  
return to your dealer/retailer for service.  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can  
cause bad injuries. To help avoid injuries to you  
and others, read and follow all the instructions  
on the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine  
when refueling. Do not smoke near fuel or when  
refueling the vehicle. Do not use cellular phones.  
(Continued)  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away  
from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is against the law  
in some places. Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away from the fuel  
pump; never let children pump fuel.  
To open the fuel filler  
door, pull up on the  
release lever with this  
symbol on it. It is located  
on the floor on the  
outboard side of the  
driver seat.  
Hatchback shown. Sedan similar  
The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel  
door on the passenger side of the vehicle.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To remove the fuel cap, turn it slowly counterclockwise.  
The fuel cap has a spring in it; if the cap is released too  
soon, it will spring back to the right.  
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it clockwise until  
it clicks. Make sure the cap is fully installed. The  
diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has  
been left off or improperly installed. This would allow  
fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 431.  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap  
too quickly. If you spill fuel and then something  
ignites it, you could be badly burned. This spray  
can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more  
likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and  
wait for any hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew the  
cap all the way.  
WARNING:  
{
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not  
remove the nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by notifying the station  
attendant. Leave the area immediately.  
Notice: If a new fuel cap is needed, be sure to get  
the right type. Your dealer/retailer can get one for  
you. The wrong type might not fit properly. This can  
cause the malfunction indicator lamp to light and  
can damage the fuel tank and emissions system.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 431.  
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not top off or overfill the  
tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished  
pumping before removing the nozzle. Clean fuel from  
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 682.  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container  
WARNING:  
Checking Things Under  
the Hood  
{
WARNING:  
{
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in  
the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel vapor. You can be  
badly burned and the vehicle damaged if this  
occurs. To help avoid injury to you and others:  
An electric fan under the hood can start up and  
injure you even when the engine is not running.  
Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
.
Dispense fuel only into approved containers.  
.
Do not fill a container while it is inside a  
vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, pickup bed, or  
on any surface other than the ground.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside  
of the fill opening before operating the nozzle.  
Contact should be maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and  
start a fire. These include liquids like fuel, oil,  
coolant, brake fluid, windshield washer and other  
fluids, and plastic or rubber. You or others could  
be burned. Be careful not to drop or spill things  
that will burn onto a hot engine.  
.
Do not smoke while pumping fuel.  
.
Do not use a cellular phone while  
pumping fuel.  
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hood Release  
To open the hood:  
1. Pull the hood release  
handle inside the  
vehicle. It is located on  
the lower left side of  
the instrument panel.  
2. At the front of the vehicle, lift up on the secondary  
hood release lever, located under the front center  
of the hood.  
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To close the hood:  
3. Lift the hood and release the hood prop from its  
retainer, located on the underside of the hood.  
Securely place the hood prop into the slot on the  
inner fender.  
1. Before closing the hood, be sure all the filler caps  
are on properly. Then, lift the hood to relieve  
pressure on the hood prop. Remove the hood prop  
from the slot in the inner fender and return the prop  
to its retainer. The prop rod must click into place  
when returning it to the retainer to prevent hood  
damage.  
2. Lower the hood 30 cm (12 inches) above the  
vehicle and release it so it fully latches. Check to  
make sure the hood is closed and repeat the  
process if necessary.  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Overview  
Automatic Transmission shown, Manual Transmission similar  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
Engine Oil  
B. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 615.  
If the engine oil pressure  
light comes on, check the  
engine oil level right away.  
C. Brake/Clutch Fluid Reservoir. See Brake Fluid”  
under Brakes on page 634 and Hydraulic Clutch  
on page 623  
D. Engine Coolant Surge Tank. See Cooling System  
on page 624  
.
.
E. Engine Compartment Fuse Block on page 689.  
F. Battery on page 637.  
The oil pressure light is on the instrument panel cluster.  
See Oil Pressure Light on page 433. Check the  
engine oil level regularly; this is an added reminder.  
G. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
page 633  
.
H. Engine Oil Dipstick. See Checking Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 615.  
I. Automatic Transmission Dipstick. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on page 620.  
J. Power Steering Fluid Reservoir. See Power  
Steering Fluid on page 632.  
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking Engine Oil  
When to Add Engine Oil  
It is a good idea to check the engine oil level at each  
fuel fill. In order to get an accurate reading, the oil must  
be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground.  
The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop. See  
Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for the  
location of the engine oil dipstick.  
1. Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes  
to drain back into the oil pan. If this is not done, the  
oil dipstick might not show the actual level.  
If the oil is below the MIN (minimum) mark on  
the dipstick, add at least one liter/quart of the  
recommended oil. This section explains what kind  
of oil to use. For engine oil crankcase capacity, see  
Capacities and Specifications on page 693.  
2. Pull the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel or  
cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it  
again, keeping the tip down and check the level.  
Notice: Do not add too much oil. If the engine has  
so much oil that the oil level gets above the upper  
mark that shows the proper operating range, the  
engine could be damaged.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the engine oil fill cap.  
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper  
operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in  
when through.  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
American Petroleum Institute (API) starburst  
symbol  
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use  
Look for three things:  
Oils meeting these  
requirements should have  
.
GM6094M  
the starburst symbol on  
the container. This symbol  
indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the  
American Petroleum  
Institute (API).  
Use only an oil that meets GM Standard  
GM6094M.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the vehicle. These numbers  
on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as  
SAE 20W-50.  
Notice: Use only engine oil identified as meeting  
GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American  
Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines  
starburst symbol. Failure to use the recommended  
oil can result in engine damage not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Temperature Operation  
Engine Oil Life System  
If in an area of extreme cold, where the temperature  
falls below 29°C (20°F), use either an SAE 5W-30  
synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30 engine oil. Both provide  
easier cold starting for the engine at extremely low  
temperatures. Always use an oil that meets the required  
specification, GM6094M. See What Kind of Engine Oil  
to Usefor more information.  
When to Change Engine Oil  
This vehicle has the Engine Oil Life System, a computer  
system that indicates when to change the engine oil  
and filter. This is based on engine revolutions and  
engine temperature, and not on mileage. Based on  
driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change is  
indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life system  
to work properly, the system must be reset every time  
the oil is changed.  
Engine Oil Additives / Engine Oil  
Flushes  
When the system has calculated that oil life has been  
diminished, it indicates that an oil change is necessary.  
A change engine oil light displays. Change the oil as  
soon as possible within the next 1 000 km (600 miles).  
It is possible that, if driving under the best conditions,  
the oil life system might not indicate that an oil change  
is necessary for over a year. However, the engine oil  
and filter must be changed at least once a year and at  
this time the system must be reset. Your dealer/retailer  
has trained service people who will perform this work  
using genuine parts and reset the system. It is also  
important to check the oil regularly and keep it at the  
proper level.  
Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended  
oils with the starburst symbol that meet GM Standard  
GM6094M are all that is needed for good performance  
and engine protection.  
Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and  
could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must  
be changed at 5 000 km (3,000 miles) since the last  
oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system  
whenever the oil is changed.  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you  
change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the  
filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in  
the trash, pouring it on the ground, into sewers, or into  
streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it to a  
place that collects used oil.  
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life  
System  
The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to change  
your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use.  
Whenever the oil is changed, reset the system so it  
can calculate when the next oil change is required. If a  
situation occurs where the oil is changed prior to a  
change engine oil light being turned on, reset the  
system.  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
The engine air cleaner/filter is located in the engine  
compartment on the passenger side of the vehicle.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
more information on location.  
After changing the engine oil, the system must be reset:  
1. With the engine off, turn the ignition key to  
ON/RUN.  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
2. Fully press and release the accelerator pedal  
slowly three times within five seconds.  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the Maintenance II  
intervals and replace it at the first oil change after  
each 50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 for more information. If you  
are driving in dusty/dirty conditions, inspect the filter at  
each engine oil change.  
3. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF, then start the vehicle.  
If the change engine oil light comes back on when the  
vehicle is started, the engine oil life system has not  
reset. Repeat the reset procedure.  
What to Do with Used Oil  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
To inspect the engine air cleaner/filter, remove the filter  
from the vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release  
loose dust and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt,  
a new filter is required.  
Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be  
unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer.  
Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean  
your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand  
cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags  
containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's  
warnings about the use and disposal of oil products.  
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To inspect or replace the air cleaner/filter:  
WARNING:  
{
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off  
can cause you or others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop  
flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when  
working on the engine and do not drive with the  
air cleaner/filter off.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily  
get into the engine, which could damage it. Always  
have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are  
driving.  
Automatic Transmission Fluid  
1. Remove the screws and lift off the cover.  
When to Check Automatic  
Transmission Fluid  
Check the automatic transmission fluid level at least  
twice a year. Add fluid if needed. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73.  
2. Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/filter.  
3. Put the cover back on tightly and tighten the  
screws.  
See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for  
replacement intervals.  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To get the right reading, the fluid should be at normal  
operating temperature, which is 158°F to 176°F (70°C  
to 80°C).  
How to Check Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
Because this operation can be a little difficult, you may  
choose to have this done at the dealer/retailer service  
department.  
Get the vehicle warmed up by driving about 15 miles  
(24 km) when outside temperatures are above 50°F  
(10°C). If it is colder than 50°F (10°C), you may have  
to drive longer.  
If you do it yourself, be sure to follow all the instructions  
here, or you could get a false reading on the dipstick.  
Checking the Fluid Level  
Notice: Too much or too little fluid can damage the  
transmission. Too much can mean that some of the  
fluid could come out and fall on hot engine parts or  
exhaust system parts, starting a fire. Too little fluid  
could cause the transmission to overheat. Be sure  
to get an accurate reading if checking the  
transmission fluid.  
Prepare the vehicle as follows:  
1. Park the vehicle on a level place. Keep the engine  
running.  
2. With the parking brake applied, place the shift  
lever in P (Park).  
3. With your foot on the brake pedal, move the shift  
lever through each gear range, pausing for about  
three seconds in each range. Then, position the  
shift lever in P (Park).  
Wait at least 30 minutes before checking the  
transmission fluid level if you have been driving:  
.
When outside temperatures are above  
90°F (32°C).  
4. Let the engine run at idle for three to five minutes.  
.
At high speed for quite a while.  
.
In heavy traffic especially in hot weather.  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then, without shutting off the engine, follow these  
steps:  
How to Add Automatic Transmission  
Fluid  
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine what  
kind of transmission fluid to use. See Recommended  
Fluids and Lubricants on page 711.  
1. Locate the automatic transmission dipstick  
which is located toward the front of the engine  
compartment, near the power steering fluid  
reservoir.  
If the fluid level is low, add only enough of the proper  
fluid to bring the level into the area between the  
two dimples in the hot range on the dipstick.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
for more information on location.  
2. Pull out the dipstick and wipe it with a clean rag or  
paper towel.  
1. Pull out the dipstick.  
2. Using a long-neck funnel, add enough fluid at the  
dipstick hole to bring it to the proper level.  
3. Push the dipstick back in all the way, wait  
three seconds, and then pull it back out again.  
It does not take much fluid, generally less than  
one pint (0.5 L). Do not overfill.  
Notice: Use of the incorrect automatic transmission  
fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damages may  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always  
use the automatic transmission fluid listed in  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 711.  
3. After adding fluid, recheck the fluid level as  
described under How to Check Automatic  
Transmission Fluidearlier in this section.  
4. Check both sides of the dipstick. The fluid should  
be between MIN (A) and MAX (B) mark of the hot  
area of the dipstick.  
4. When the correct fluid level is obtained, push the  
dipstick back in all the way.  
5. If the fluid level is in the acceptable range, push  
the dipstick back in all the way.  
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When to Check and What to Use  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
Refer to the Maintenance Schedule to determine how  
often to check the fluid level in the master cylinder  
reservoir and for the proper fluid. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 and Recommended Fluids  
and Lubricants on page 711.  
It is not necessary to check the transmission fluid  
level. A transmission fluid leak is the only reason for  
fluid loss. If a leak occurs, take the vehicle to the  
dealer/retailer service department and have it repaired  
as soon as possible. See Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 711 for the proper fluid to use.  
Hydraulic Clutch  
There is one reservoir for both the brake and the  
hydraulic clutch fluid. See Brakes on page 634 for  
more information.  
The hydraulic clutch linkage in the vehicle is  
self-adjusting. The master cylinder reservoir is filled  
with hydraulic fluid.  
A fluid loss in this system could indicate a problem.  
Have the system inspected and repaired.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Check and Add Fluid  
Cooling System  
The reservoir is located near the back of the engine  
compartment on the driver side of the vehicle.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614  
for more information on location.  
The cooling system allows the engine to maintain the  
correct working temperature.  
A. Electric Engine Cooling Fan  
B. Coolant Surge Tank with Pressure Cap  
To check the fluid level, look on the side of the  
reservoir. If the fluid reaches the MAX (A) mark on the  
reservoir, the fluid level is correct. If the fluid does not  
reach the MIN (B) mark on the reservoir, then fluid  
needs to be added.  
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Using coolant other than DEXCOOL® can  
cause premature engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant may  
require changing sooner, at the first maintenance  
service after each 30,000 miles (50 000 km) or  
24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use DEXCOOL® (silicatefree) coolant in  
the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
Engine Coolant  
WARNING:  
{
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with  
DEX-COOL® engine coolant. This coolant is designed  
to remain in the vehicle for five years or 150,000 miles  
(240 000 km), whichever occurs first.  
Heater and radiator hoses, and other engine  
parts, can be very hot. Do not touch them. If you  
do, you can be burned.  
The following explains the cooling system and how  
to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is  
a problem with engine overheating, see Engine  
Overheating on page 630.  
Do not run the engine if there is a leak. If you run  
the engine, it could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you could be burned.  
Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Protects against rust and corrosion.  
Will not damage aluminum parts.  
What to Use  
Helps keep the proper engine temperature.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used, the  
engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The  
repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze  
and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and  
other parts.  
Adding only plain water to the cooling system  
can be dangerous. Plain water, or some other  
liquid such as alcohol, can boil before the proper  
coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning  
system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With  
plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could  
get too hot but you would not get the overheat  
warning. The engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant.  
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used  
in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be  
damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine  
coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711 for more information.  
Checking Coolant  
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking  
the coolant level.  
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and  
DEX-COOL® coolant. If using this mixture, nothing else  
needs to be added. This mixture:  
.
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant surge  
tank. If the coolant inside the coolant surge tank is  
boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.  
Gives freezing protection down to 34°F (37°C),  
outside temperature.  
.
Gives boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C),  
engine temperature.  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not between  
the Minimum and Maximum marks, add a 50/50 mixture  
of clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant at  
the coolant surge tank, but be sure the cooling system  
is cool before this is done. See Engine Coolant on  
page 625 for more information.  
WARNING:  
{
Turning the surge tank pressure cap when the  
engine and radiator are hot can allow steam and  
scalding liquids to blow out and burn you badly.  
Never turn the surge tank pressure cap even a  
little when the engine and radiator are hot.  
When the engine is cold, the coolant level should be  
between the Maximum (A) and Minimum (B) marks  
on the coolant surge tank. The level rises at engine  
operation temperature and drops again when the engine  
cools down.  
The coolant should be between the Maximum (A) and  
Minimum (B) marks, when the engine is cold. If it is not,  
there could be a leak in the cooling system.  
The engine coolant surge tank is located in the rear  
of the engine compartment on the driver side of the  
vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 614 for more information on location.  
6-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Add Coolant to the Coolant  
Surge Tank  
WARNING:  
{
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling  
system can blow out and burn you badly. They  
are under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank  
pressure cap even a little they can come  
out at high speed. Never turn the cap when the  
cooling system, including the surge tank pressure  
cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge  
tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn  
the pressure cap.  
WARNING:  
{
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough.  
Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.  
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill  
procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could  
cause the engine to overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
If no coolant is visible in the surge tank, add coolant as  
follows:  
1. Remove the coolant surge tank pressure cap  
when the cooling system, including the coolant  
surge tank pressure cap and upper radiator hose,  
is no longer hot. Turn the pressure cap slowly  
counterclockwise about two or two and one-half  
turns.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop. This will  
allow any pressure still left to be vented out the  
discharge hose.  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Then keep turning the pressure cap slowly and  
remove it.  
3. Fill the coolant surge tank with the proper mixture  
to the Maximum mark on the coolant surge tank.  
Wait about five minutes, then check to see if the  
level is below the mark. If the level is below the  
Maximum mark, add additional coolant to bring the  
level up to the mark.  
Repeat this procedure until the level remains  
constant at the Maximum mark for at least  
five minutes.  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. With the coolant surge tank pressure cap off, start  
the engine and let it run until you can feel the  
upper radiator hose getting hot. Watch out for the  
engine cooling fan.  
Then check to see if the engine cooling fan is running.  
If the engine is overheating, the fan should be running.  
If it is not, do not continue to run the engine and have  
the vehicle serviced.  
By this time, the coolant level inside the coolant  
surge tank may be lower. If the level is lower than  
the Maximum mark, add more of the proper  
mixture to the coolant surge tank until the level  
reaches the mark.  
Notice: Engine damage from running the engine  
without coolant is not covered by the warranty.  
Notice: If the engine catches fire because of being  
driven with no coolant, your vehicle can be badly  
damaged. The costly repairs would not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
5. Replace the pressure cap. Be sure the pressure  
cap is hand-tight and fully seated.  
If Steam Is Coming From The Engine  
Compartment  
Notice: If the pressure cap is not tightly installed,  
coolant loss and possible engine damage may  
occur. Be sure the cap is properly and tightly  
secured.  
WARNING:  
{
Engine Overheating  
Steam from an overheated engine can burn you  
badly, even if you just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear steam coming  
from it. Just turn it off and get everyone away from  
the vehicle until it cools down. Wait until there is  
no sign of steam or coolant before you open  
the hood.  
The vehicle has an indicator to warn of the engine  
overheating.  
There is a coolant temperature gauge on the instrument  
panel cluster. See Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
on page 430  
.
You may decide not to lift the hood when this warning  
appears, but instead get service help right away. See  
Roadside Assistance Program on page 87.  
(Continued)  
If you do decide to lift the hood, make sure the vehicle  
is parked on a level surface.  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the overheat warning is displayed with no sign of  
steam:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
1. Turn the air conditioning off.  
2. Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and  
to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as  
necessary.  
If you keep driving when your engine is  
overheated, the liquids in it can catch fire. You or  
others could be badly burned. Stop your engine if  
it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the  
engine is cool.  
3. If in a traffic jam, let the engine idle in N (Neutral)  
while stopped. If it is safe to do so, pull off the  
road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and let the  
engine idle.  
If No Steam Is Coming From The  
Engine Compartment  
If an engine overheat warning is displayed but no steam  
can be seen or heard, the problem may not be too  
serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too hot  
when the vehicle:  
If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in  
the overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer  
displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive  
the vehicle slow for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe  
vehicle distance from the car in front of you. If the  
warning does not come back on, continue to drive  
normally.  
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.  
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the  
vehicle right away.  
.
Stops after high-speed driving.  
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.  
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for  
three minutes while parked. If the warning is still  
displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Steering Fluid  
When to Check Power Steering Fluid  
The power steering fluid reservoir is located toward the  
front of the engine compartment on the driver's side of  
the vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 614 for reservoir location.  
It is not necessary to regularly check power steering  
fluid unless you suspect there is a leak in the system or  
you hear an unusual noise. A fluid loss in this system  
could indicate a problem. Have the system inspected  
and repaired.  
How to Check Power Steering Fluid  
Turn the key off and let the engine compartment  
cool down.  
The level should be above the MIN mark on the  
reservoir. If the level drops below the MIN mark, add  
power steering fluid. Do not overfill the reservoir and  
remember to replace the cap tightly when you are  
finished and clean up any spilled fluid.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice:  
What to Use  
To determine what kind of fluid to use, see  
.
When using concentrated washer fluid,  
follow the manufacturer's instructions for  
adding water.  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 711  
Always use the proper fluid. Failure to use the proper  
.
fluid can cause leaks and damage hoses and seals.  
.
Do not mix water with ready-to-use washer  
fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze  
and damage the washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system. Also, water does  
not clean as well as washer fluid.  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
What to Use  
When you need windshield washer fluid, be sure to  
read the manufacturer's instructions before use. If you  
will be operating your vehicle in an area where the  
temperature may fall below freezing, use a fluid that has  
sufficient protection against freezing.  
.
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only three-quarters  
full when it is very cold. This allows for fluid  
expansion if freezing occurs, which could  
damage the tank if it is completely full.  
Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in  
the windshield washer. It can damage the  
vehicle's windshield washer system and  
paint.  
Adding Washer Fluid  
Open the cap with the  
washer symbol on it.  
Add washer fluid until the  
tank is full. See Engine  
Compartment Overview  
on page 614 for  
reservoir location.  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not top off the brake fluid. Adding brake fluid does  
not correct a leak. If fluid is added when the linings are  
worn, there will be too much fluid when new brake  
linings are installed. Add or remove fluid, as necessary,  
only when work is done on the brake or clutch hydraulic  
system.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
The vehicle has one  
reservoir for both the  
brake and clutch hydraulic  
systems. It is filled with  
DOT 3 brake fluid.  
WARNING:  
{
If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on the  
engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough. You  
or others could be burned, and the vehicle could  
be damaged. Add brake fluid only when work is  
done on the brake and/or clutch hydraulic system.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 614 for  
the location of the reservoir.  
When the brake fluid falls to a low level, the brake  
warning light comes on. See Brake System Warning  
Light on page 428.  
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in  
the reservoir might go down:  
What to Add  
.
The brake fluid level goes down because of normal  
brake lining wear. When new linings are installed,  
the fluid level goes back up.  
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid from a sealed  
container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711  
.
.
A fluid leak in the brake or clutch hydraulic system  
can also cause a low fluid level. Have the brake or  
clutch hydraulic system fixed, since a leak means  
that sooner or later the brakes will not work well.  
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area  
around the cap before removing it. This helps keep dirt  
from entering the reservoir.  
6-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brake Wear  
This vehicle has front disc brakes and could have rear  
drum brakes or rear disc brakes.  
WARNING:  
{
With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake or clutch  
hydraulic system, the brakes or clutch might not  
work well. This could cause a crash. Always use  
the proper brake fluid.  
Disc brake pads have built-in wear indicators that make  
a high-pitched warning sound when the brake pads are  
worn and new pads are needed. The sound can come  
and go or be heard all the time the vehicle is moving,  
except when applying the brake pedal firmly.  
Notice:  
.
WARNING:  
{
Using the wrong fluid can badly damage  
brake or clutch hydraulic system parts. For  
example, just a few drops of mineral-based  
oil, such as engine oil, in the brake or clutch  
hydraulic system can damage brake or  
clutch hydraulic system parts so badly that  
they will have to be replaced. Do not let  
someone put in the wrong kind of fluid.  
The brake wear warning sound means that soon  
the brakes will not work well. That could lead to  
an accident. When the brake wear warning sound  
is heard, have the vehicle serviced.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with worn-out brake  
pads could result in costly brake repair.  
.
If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's  
painted surfaces, the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to spill brake  
fluid on the vehicle. If you do, wash it off  
immediately. See Washing Your Vehicle on  
Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake  
squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean something is wrong with  
the brakes.  
page 682  
.
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help  
prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated,  
inspect brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel  
nuts in the proper sequence to torque specifications in  
Capacities and Specifications on page 693.  
Brake Adjustment  
Every moderate brake stop, the disc brakes adjust for  
wear. If rarely making moderate or heavier brake stops,  
the brakes might not adjust correctly. Very carefully  
making a few moderate brake stops about every  
1 600 km (1,000 miles) will adjust the brakes properly.  
If the vehicle has rear drum brakes, they do not have  
wear indicators, but if a rear brake rubbing noise  
is heard, have the rear brake linings inspected  
immediately. Rear brake drums should be removed  
and inspected each time the tires are removed for  
rotation or changing. When the front brake pads are  
replaced, have the rear brakes inspected, too.  
If the vehicle has rear drum brakes and the brake pedal  
goes down farther than normal, the rear drum brakes  
might need adjustment. Adjust them by backing up and  
firmly applying the brakes a few times.  
Replacing Brake System Parts  
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete  
axle sets.  
The braking system on a vehicle is complex. Its many  
parts have to be of top quality and work well together if  
the vehicle is to have really good braking. The vehicle  
was designed and tested with top-quality brake parts.  
When parts of the braking system are replaced for  
example, when the brake linings wear down and new  
ones are installed be sure to get new approved  
replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example, if someone puts in  
brake linings that are wrong for the vehicle, the balance  
between the front and rear brakes can change for the  
worse. The braking performance expected can change  
in many other ways if the wrong replacement brake  
parts are installed.  
Brake Pedal Travel  
See your dealer/retailer if the brake pedal does not  
return to normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in  
pedal travel. This could be a sign that brake service  
might be required.  
6-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Storage  
Battery  
Refer to the replacement number on the original battery  
label when a new battery is needed. See Engine  
Compartment Overview on page 614 for battery  
location.  
WARNING:  
{
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas  
that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you are  
not careful. See Jump Starting on page 638 for  
tips on working around a battery without  
getting hurt.  
DANGER:  
{
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer  
and reproductive harm. Wash hands after  
handling.  
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative () cable  
from the battery to keep the battery from running down.  
Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative ()  
cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger.  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Ignoring these steps could result in costly  
damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by  
the warranty.  
Jump Starting  
If the vehicle's battery has run down, you may want to  
use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start  
your vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it  
safely.  
Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it  
will not work, and it could damage the vehicle.  
1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt  
battery with a negative ground system.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: If the other vehicle's system is not a 12-volt  
system with a negative ground, both vehicles can  
be damaged. Only use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle.  
Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous  
because:  
.
2. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper  
cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not  
touching each other. If they are, it could cause a  
ground connection you do not want. You would  
not be able to start your vehicle, and the bad  
grounding could damage the electrical systems.  
They contain acid that can burn you.  
.
They contain gas that can explode or ignite.  
.
They contain enough electricity to burn you.  
If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or  
all of these things can hurt you.  
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set  
the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved  
in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic  
transmission in P (Park) or a manual transmission  
in N (Neutral) before setting the parking brake.  
6-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If you leave the radio or other accessories  
on during the jump starting procedure, they could  
be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by  
the warranty. Always turn off the radio and other  
accessories when jump starting the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Using a match near a battery can cause battery  
gas to explode. People have been hurt doing this,  
and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if  
you need more light.  
3. Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug  
unnecessary accessories plugged into the  
cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet.  
Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not  
needed. This will avoid sparks and help save both  
batteries. And it could save the radio!  
Be sure the battery has enough water. You do not  
need to add water to the battery installed in your  
new vehicle. But if a battery has filler caps, be  
sure the right amount of fluid is there. If it is low,  
add water to take care of that first. If you don't,  
explosive gas could be present.  
4. Open the hoods and locate the batteries. Find the  
positive (+) and negative () terminal locations on  
each vehicle. See Engine Compartment Overview  
on page 614 for more information on location.  
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you. Do  
not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in your  
eyes or on your skin, flush the place with water  
and get medical help immediately.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan can start up even when the engine  
is not running and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any underhood  
electric fan.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you  
badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts  
once the engine is running.  
5. Check that the jumper cables do not have loose  
or missing insulation. If they do, you could get a  
shock. The vehicles could be damaged too.  
Before you connect the cables, here are some  
things you should know. Positive (+) will go to  
positive (+) or to a remote positive (+) terminal if  
the vehicle has one. Negative () will go to a  
heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the  
positive (+) terminal of the dead battery. Use a  
remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Do not connect positive (+) to negative () or you  
will get a short that would damage the battery and  
maybe other parts too. And do not connect the  
negative () cable to the negative () terminal on  
the dead battery because this can cause sparks.  
6-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to  
the positive (+) terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.  
8. Now connect the black negative () cable to the  
negative () terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Do not let the other end touch anything until the  
next step. The other end of the negative () cable  
does not go to the dead battery. It goes to a  
heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal on the vehicle with the dead  
battery.  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Connect the other end of the negative () cable  
at least 18 inches (45 cm) away from the dead  
battery, but not near engine parts that move.  
The electrical connection is just as good there, and  
the chance of sparks getting back to the battery is  
much less.  
10. Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run  
the engine for a while.  
11. Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery.  
If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs  
service.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are connected or  
removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting may  
occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always  
connect and remove the jumper cables in the  
correct order, making sure that the cables do not  
touch each other or other metal.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote  
Negative () Terminal  
B. Good Battery or Remote Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote Positive (+) Terminal  
6-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles, do  
the following:  
Bulb Replacement  
For the proper type of replacement bulbs, see  
Replacement Bulbs on page 649.  
1. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle that had the dead battery.  
For any bulb changing procedure not listed in this  
section, contact your dealer/retailer.  
2. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
Halogen Bulbs  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the other  
vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Headlamp Aiming  
Headlamp aim has been preset at the factory and  
should need no further adjustment.  
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and  
can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb. You or  
others could be injured. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions on the bulb package.  
However, if your vehicle is damaged in a crash, the  
headlamp aim may be affected. Aim adjustment to the  
low-beam headlamps may be necessary if oncoming  
drivers flash their high-beam headlamps at you (for  
vertical aim).  
If the headlamps need to be re-aimed, it is  
recommended that you take the vehicle to your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamps  
To replace a headlamp bulb:  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 612.  
4. Remove the headlamp cap.  
5. Release the spring that retains the bulb by  
loosening the screw.  
6. Remove the old bulb and install the new bulb.  
7. Install the bulb retaining spring and tighten the  
screw.  
8. Reinstall the headlamp cap.  
2. Remove the three bolts to remove the headlamp  
assembly.  
9. Reconnect the wiring harness at the rear of  
the bulb.  
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the  
rear of the bulb.  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker and  
Parking Lamps  
To replace a front turn signal or parking lamp bulb:  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 612  
for more information.  
10. Reinstall the headlamp assembly using the three  
bolts.  
2. Remove the three bolts to remove the headlamp  
assembly.  
3. Disconnect the wiring harness connector from the  
rear of the bulb.  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Install the new bulb into the socket by pressing it in  
and turning it clockwise.  
8. Install the socket into the lamp housing by turning  
it clockwise.  
9. Reconnect the wiring harness connector at the rear  
of the bulb.  
4. Turn the front turn signal bulb socket  
counterclockwise.  
5. Pull the front turn signal bulb socket out of the  
lamp housing.  
6. Press the bulb inward and turn it counterclockwise  
to remove it from the bulb socket.  
10. Reinstall the headlamp assembly using the three  
bolts.  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp  
(CHMSL) (Hatchback)  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp  
(CHMSL) (Sedan)  
To replace a CHMSL bulb on the hatchback:  
To replace a CHMSL bulb on the sedan:  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate (Hatchback) on  
page 310 for more information.  
1. Open the trunk. See Trunk on page 38 for more  
information.  
2. Remove the two screws and the lamp housing.  
Disconnect the wiring harness connector before  
removing the lamp housing.  
2. Pull down on the lamp assembly while holding the  
end of the bracket.  
3. Remove the lens cover using a flat head  
screwdriver.  
3. Remove the five screws and the reflector  
assembly.  
4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out of the  
bulb holder.  
4. Remove the bulb by pulling it straight out of the  
bulb holder.  
5. Install the new bulb.  
5. Install the new bulb.  
6. Reverse Steps 1 through 3 to reinstall.  
6. Reverse Steps 1 through 3 to reinstall.  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Sidemarker,  
Stoplamps and Back-up Lamps  
To replace a taillamp, turn signal lamp, stoplamp,  
or back-up bulb:  
1. Open the liftgate or trunk. See Liftgate (Hatchback)  
on page 310 or Trunk on page 38.  
Sedan  
2. Remove the two screws and the lamp assembly.  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and remove  
the socket.  
4. Press the bulb in and turn counterclockwise to  
remove from the socket.  
5. Press the new bulb in and turn clockwise to install  
the bulb into the socket.  
Hatchback  
6. Turn the bulb socket clockwise to reinstall.  
7. Reinstall the lamp assembly and two screws.  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Push the bulb straight into the socket and turn  
clockwise to reinstall.  
License Plate Lamp  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
6. Push and turn the license plate lamp away from  
you through the opening.  
7. Reinstall the two screws holding the license  
plate lamp.  
Replacement Bulbs  
Exterior Lamp  
Back-Up Lamps  
Bulb Number  
94535571  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp  
(CHMSL)  
94535587  
Front Parking/Turn Signal Lamps  
Front Sidemarker Lamps  
Headlamps  
94535578  
94535578  
94535548  
94535587  
94535577  
94535572  
94535577  
License Plate Lamp  
1. Remove the two screws holding each of the  
license plate lamps.  
Rear Sidemarker Lamps  
Rear Turn Signal Lamps  
Stoplamp/Taillamps  
2. Turn and pull the license plate lamp toward you  
through the opening.  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull the  
bulb straight out of the socket.  
For replacement bulbs not listed here, contact your  
dealer/retailer.  
4. Install the new bulb.  
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here is how to remove and replace the windshield wiper  
blade:  
Windshield Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be inspected for wear  
or cracking. See Wiper Blade Checkfor more  
information.  
1. Pull the windshield wiper arm away from the  
windshield.  
Replacement blades come in different types and  
are removed in different ways. For the proper type,  
see Maintenance Replacement Parts on page 713.  
2. Press the retaining clip (A) and pull the wiper blade  
off the arm.  
3. Install a new blade by reversing Steps 1 and 2.  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Your new vehicle comes with high-quality tires  
made by a leading tire manufacturer. If you ever  
have questions about your tire warranty and  
where to obtain service, see your vehicle  
Warranty booklet for details. For additional  
information refer to the tire manufacturer.  
.
Underinflated tires pose the same  
danger as overloaded tires. The resulting  
accident could cause serious injury.  
Check all tires frequently to maintain the  
recommended pressure. Tire pressure  
should be checked when your vehicle's  
tires are cold. See Inflation - Tire  
WARNING:  
{
Pressure on page 658  
.
.
.
Poorly maintained and improperly used tires  
are dangerous.  
Overinflated tires are more likely to be  
cut, punctured, or broken by a sudden  
impact such as when you hit a pothole.  
Keep tires at the recommended pressure.  
.
Overloading your vehicle's tires can  
cause overheating as a result of too  
much flexing. You could have an air-out  
and a serious accident. See Loading the  
Worn, old tires can cause accidents.  
If the tire's tread is badly worn, or if your  
vehicle's tires have been damaged,  
replace them.  
Vehicle on page 515  
.
(Continued)  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a combination of  
letters and numbers used to define a particular  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction  
type and service description. See the Tire Size”  
illustration later in this section for more detail.  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Useful information about a tire is molded into its  
sidewall. The examples below show a typical  
passenger car tire and a compact spare tire  
sidewall.  
(B) DOT (Department of Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation (DOT) code  
indicates that the tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
(C) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following DOT code are the Tire  
Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date  
the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded  
onto both sides of the tire, although only one side  
may have the date of manufacture.  
(D) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(E) Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG): Tire  
manufacturers are required to grade tires based  
on three performance factors: treadwear, traction  
and temperature resistance. For more information  
Passenger Car Tire Example  
see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 666  
.
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(F) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
For information on recommended tire pressure  
see Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 658 and  
(A) Temporary Use Only: The compact spare  
tire or temporary use tire has a tread life of  
approximately 3,000 miles (5 000 km) and should  
not be driven at speeds over 65 mph (105 km/h).  
The compact spare tire is for emergency use  
when a regular road tire has lost air and gone flat.  
See Compact Spare Tire on page 678 and If a  
Loading the Vehicle on page 515  
.
Tire Goes Flat on page 669  
.
(B) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(C) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The Tire  
Identification Number (TIN). The TIN shows the  
manufacturer and plant code, tire size, and date  
the tire was manufactured. The TIN is molded  
onto both sides of the tire, although only one side  
may have the date of manufacture.  
Compact Spare Tire Example  
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(D) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
See Compact Spare Tire on page 678 and  
Tire Size  
The following illustration shows an example of a  
typical passenger car tire size.  
Loading the Vehicle on page 515  
.
(E) Tire Inflation: The temporary use tire or  
compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For more information on tire pressure  
and inflation see Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
page 658  
.
(F) Tire Size : A combination of letters and  
numbers define a tire's width, height, aspect ratio,  
construction type and service description. The  
letter T as the first character in the tire size means  
the tire is for temporary use only.  
(A) Passenger (PMetric) Tire: The United  
States version of a metric tire sizing system.  
The letter P as the first character in the tire size  
means a passenger vehicle tire engineered to  
standards set by the U. S. Tire and Rim  
Association.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit number indicates  
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall  
to sidewall.  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit number that  
Tire Terminology and Definitions  
indicates the tire heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 70, as  
shown in item C of the illustration, it would mean  
that the tire's sidewall is 70% as high as it is wide.  
Air Pressure: The amount of air inside the tire  
pressing outward on each square inch of the tire.  
Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square  
inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).  
(D) Construction Code: A letter code is used  
to indicate the type of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means beltedbias ply  
construction.  
Accessory Weight: This means the combined  
weight of optional accessories. Some examples of  
optional accessories are, automatic transmission,  
power steering, power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air conditioning.  
Aspect Ratio: The relationship of a tire's height to  
its width.  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of the wheel in  
inches.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of cords that is  
located between the plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other reinforcing  
materials.  
(F) Service Description: These characters  
represent the load index and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents the load carry  
capacity a tire is certified to carry. The speed  
rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to  
carry a load.  
Bead: The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped  
by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim.  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the plies  
are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees  
to the centerline of the tread.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Tire Pressure: The amount of air pressure  
in a tire, measured in pounds per square inch (psi)  
or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built up heat  
from driving. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Intended Outboard Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire, that must always face outward  
when mounted on a vehicle.  
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric unit for air pressure.  
page 658  
.
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: A tire used on light  
duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger  
vehicles.  
Curb Weight: The weight of a motor vehicle with  
standard and optional equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but  
without passengers and cargo.  
Load Index: An assigned number ranging from  
1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying  
capacity of a tire.  
DOT Markings: A code molded into the sidewall  
of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance  
with the U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT)  
motor vehicle safety standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an  
alphanumeric designator which can also identify  
the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand, and  
date of production.  
Maximum Inflation Pressure: The maximum  
air pressure to which a cold tire can be inflated.  
The maximum air pressure is molded onto the  
sidewall.  
Maximum Load Rating: The load rating for a tire  
at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for  
that tire.  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 515  
.
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight: The sum of  
curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity  
weight, and production options weight.  
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the  
front axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 515  
.
Normal Occupant Weight: The number of  
occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied  
by 150 lbs (68 kg). See Loading the Vehicle on  
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear  
axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 515  
.
page 515  
.
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Occupant Distribution: Designated seating  
positions.  
Speed Rating: An alphanumeric code assigned  
to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a  
tire can operate.  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that  
faces outward when mounted on a vehicle. The  
side of the tire that contains a whitewall, bears  
white lettering, or bears manufacturer, brand,  
and/or model name molding that is higher or  
deeper than the same moldings on the other  
sidewall of the tire.  
Traction: The friction between the tire and the  
road surface. The amount of grip provided.  
Tread: The portion of a tire that comes into  
contact with the road.  
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow bands, sometimes  
called wear bars, that show across the tread of  
a tire when only 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread  
remains. See When It Is Time for New Tires on  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A tire used on  
passenger cars and some light duty trucks and  
multipurpose vehicles.  
page 664  
.
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
Standards): A tire information system that  
provides consumers with ratings for a tire's  
traction, temperature, and treadwear. Ratings  
are determined by tire manufacturers using  
government testing procedures. The ratings are  
molded into the sidewall of the tire. See Uniform  
Recommended Inflation Pressure: Vehicle  
manufacturer's recommended tire inflation  
pressure as shown on the tire placard. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 658 and Loading  
the Vehicle on page 515  
.
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the  
ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at  
90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.  
Tire Quality Grading on page 666  
.
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The number of  
Rim: A metal support for a tire and upon which  
the tire beads are seated.  
designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs  
(68 kg) plus the rated cargo load. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 515  
.
Sidewall: The portion of a tire between the tread  
and the bead.  
6-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire: Load on  
an individual tire due to curb weight, accessory  
weight, occupant weight, and cargo weight.  
If your tires have too much air (overinflation),  
you can get the following:  
.
Unusual wear  
Vehicle Placard: A label permanently attached  
to a vehicle showing the vehicle's capacity  
weight and the original equipment tire size and  
recommended inflation pressure. See Tire and  
Loading Information Labelunder Loading the  
.
Poor handling  
.
Rough ride  
.
Needless damage from road hazards  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to your vehicle. This label shows  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressures for your tires when they  
are cold. The recommended cold tire inflation  
pressure, shown on the label, is the minimum  
amount of air pressure needed to support your  
vehicle's maximum load carrying capacity.  
Vehicle on page 515  
.
Inflation - Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to  
operate effectively.  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell you that  
underinflation or overinflation is all right.  
It is not. If your tires do not have enough air  
(underinflation), you can get the following:  
For additional information regarding how much  
weight your vehicle can carry, and an example  
of the Tire and Loading Information label, see  
Loading the Vehicle on page 515. How you load  
your vehicle affects vehicle handling and ride  
comfort. Never load your vehicle with more weight  
than it was designed to carry.  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Too much flexing  
Too much heat  
Tire overloading  
Premature or irregular wear  
Poor handling  
Reduced fuel economy  
6-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on  
the metal stem in the center of the tire valve.  
Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gauge.  
When to Check  
Check your tires once a month or more. Do not  
forget to check the compact spare tire, it should  
be at 60 psi (420 kPa). For additional information  
regarding the compact spare tire, see Compact  
Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve  
stems. They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt  
and moisture.  
Spare Tire on page 678  
.
How to Check  
Tire Pressure Monitor System  
Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to check  
tire pressure. You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by looking at them.  
Radial tires may look properly inflated even  
when they are underinflated. Check the tire's  
inflation pressure when the tires are cold.  
Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no more than  
1 mile (1.6 km).  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses radio  
and sensor technology to check tire pressure levels.  
The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in your  
vehicle's tires and transmit tire pressure readings to a  
receiver located in the vehicle.  
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be  
checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation  
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label.  
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure  
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem.  
Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a  
pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation  
pressure matches the recommended pressure on  
the Tire and Loading Information label, no further  
adjustment is necessary. If the inflation pressure  
is low, add air until you reach the recommended  
amount.  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been  
equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when  
one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated.  
6-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale  
illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as  
soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper  
pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.  
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and  
stopping ability.  
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after  
replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle  
to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and  
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 660 for  
additional information.  
Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and Industry  
Canada  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 820 for  
information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper  
tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to  
maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation  
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the  
TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS  
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not  
operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is  
combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash  
for approximately one minute and then remain  
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue  
upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the  
malfunction exists.  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS). The TPMS is designed to warn the driver when  
a low tire pressure condition exists. If your vehicle has  
this feature, the TPMS sensors are mounted onto each  
tire and wheel assembly, excluding the spare tire and  
wheel assembly. The TPMS sensors monitor the air  
pressure in your vehicle's tires and transmit tire  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the  
system may not be able to detect or signal low tire  
pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur  
for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle  
that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.  
pressure readings to a receiver located in the vehicle.  
6-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Liquid tire sealants could damage the Tire  
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) sensors. Sensor  
damage caused by using a tire sealant is not  
covered by your warranty. Do not use liquid tire  
sealants.  
When a low tire pressure  
condition is detected, the  
TPMS illuminates the low  
tire pressure warning light  
on the instrument panel  
cluster.  
TPMS Malfunction Light  
The TPMS will not function properly if one or more of  
the TPMS sensors are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the low tire warning light  
flashes for about one minute and then stays on for the  
remainder of the ignition cycle. The low tire warning  
light comes on at each ignition cycle until the problem  
is corrected. Some of the conditions that can cause the  
malfunction light to come on are:  
The low tire pressure warning light comes on at each  
ignition cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct  
inflation pressure.  
The tire pressure warning light may come on in cool  
weather when the vehicle is first started, and then turn  
off as you start to drive. This could be an early indicator  
that the tire pressures are getting low and need to be  
inflated to the proper pressure.  
.
One of the road tires has been replaced with the  
spare tire. The spare tire does not have a TPMS  
sensor. The TPMS malfunction light should go off  
once you reinstall the road tire containing the  
TPMS sensor.  
A Tire and Loading Information label, attached to  
your vehicle, shows the size of your vehicle's original  
equipment tires and the correct inflation pressure for  
your vehicle's tires when they are cold. See Loading  
the Vehicle on page 515, for an example of the tire  
information label and its location on your vehicle. Also  
see Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 658.  
.
One or more TPMS sensors are missing or  
damaged. The TPMS malfunction light should  
go off when the TPMS sensors are installed  
and the sensor matching process is performed  
successfully. See your dealer/retailer for service.  
Your vehicle's TPMS system can warn you about a low  
tire pressure condition but it does not replace normal  
tire maintenance. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 662 and Tires on page 651.  
6-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Replacement tires or wheels do not match your  
vehicle's original equipment tires or wheels.  
Tires and wheels other than those recommended  
for your vehicle could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying New Tires on  
Tire Inspection and Rotation  
We recommend that you regularly inspect your  
vehicle's tires, including the spare tire, for signs  
of wear or damage. See When It Is Time for New  
Tires on page 664 for more information.  
page 664  
.
.
Operating electronic devices or being near facilities  
using radio wave frequencies similar to the TPMS  
could cause the TPMS sensors to malfunction.  
Tires should be rotated every 5,000 to 8,000 miles  
(8 000 to 13 000 km). See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73  
.
If the TPMS is not functioning it cannot detect or signal  
a low tire condition. See your dealer/retailer for service  
if the TPMS malfunction light comes on and stays on.  
The purpose of a regular tire rotation is to achieve  
a uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle. This will  
ensure that your vehicle continues to perform  
most like it did when the tires were new.  
TPMS Sensor Identification Codes  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code.  
Any time you replace one or more of the TPMS  
sensors, or rotate the vehicle's tires, the identification  
codes need to be matched to the new tire/wheel  
position. The sensors are matched, to the tire/wheel  
positions, in the following order: driver side front tire,  
passenger side front tire, passenger side rear tire, and  
driver side rear tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool. See  
your dealer/retailer for service.  
Any time you notice unusual wear, rotate your  
tires as soon as possible and check wheel  
alignment. Also check for damaged tires or  
wheels. See When It Is Time for New Tires on  
page 664 and Wheel Replacement on page 668  
for more information.  
6-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to  
which it is fastened, can make wheel nuts  
become loose after time. The wheel could  
come off and cause an accident. When you  
change a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from  
places where the wheel attaches to the  
vehicle. In an emergency, you can use a  
cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be  
sure to use a scraper or wire brush later,  
if needed, to get all the rust or dirt off.  
When rotating your tires, always use the correct  
rotation pattern shown here.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 670  
.
Do not include the compact spare tire in the tire  
rotation.  
After the tires have been rotated, adjust the front  
and rear inflation pressures as shown on the tire  
and loading information label. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 515 for an example of the tire  
and loading information label and where it is  
located on your vehicle. Make certain that all  
wheel nuts are properly tightened. See Wheel  
Nut Torqueunder Capacities and Specifications  
on page 693  
.
6-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The tire has a bump, bulge, or split.  
When It Is Time for New Tires  
Various factors, such as maintenance, temperatures,  
driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road conditions  
influence when you need new tires.  
The tire has a puncture, cut, or other damage that  
cannot be repaired well because of the size or  
location of the damage.  
The rubber in tires degrades over time, even if they  
are not being used. This is also true for the spare tire,  
if your vehicle has one. Multiple conditions affect how  
fast this aging takes place, including temperatures,  
loading conditions, and inflation pressure maintenance.  
With proper care and maintenance tires will typically  
wear out before they degrade due to age. If you are  
unsure about the need to replace your tires as they get  
older, consult the tire manufacturer for more information.  
One way to tell when it is  
time for new tires is to  
check the treadwear  
indicators, which will  
appear when your tires  
have only 1/16 inch  
(1.6 mm) or less of tread  
remaining.  
Buying New Tires  
GM has developed and matched specific tires for your  
vehicle. If you need replacement tires, GM strongly  
recommends that you get tires that are the same size,  
brand, load range, speed rating, and construction type  
(radial and biasbelted tires) as your vehicle's original  
tires. This way, your vehicle will continue to have tires  
that are designed to give the same performance and  
vehicle safety, during normal use, as the original tires.  
See Tire Sidewall Labeling on page 652 for additional  
information.  
You need new tires if any of the following statements  
are true:  
.
You can see the indicators at three or more places  
around the tire.  
.
You can see cord or fabric showing through the  
tire's rubber.  
.
The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut, or snagged  
deep enough to show cord or fabric.  
6-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GM recommends replacing tires in sets of four. This is  
because uniform tread depth on all tires will help keep  
your vehicle performing most like it did when the tires  
were new. Replacing less than a full set of tires can  
affect the braking and handling performance of your  
vehicle. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on page 662.  
WARNING:  
{
If you use bias-ply tires on the vehicle, the  
wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel  
could fail suddenly, causing a crash. Use  
only radial-ply tires with the wheels on the  
vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Mixing tires could cause you to lose  
control while driving. If you mix tires of  
different sizes, brands, or types (radial and  
bias-belted tires), the vehicle may not handle  
properly, and you could have a crash. Using  
tires of different sizes, brands, or types may  
also cause damage to your vehicle. Be sure  
to use the correct size, brand, and type of  
tires on all wheels. It is all right to drive with  
your compact spare temporarily, as it was  
developed for use on your vehicle. See  
Vehicles that have a tire pressure monitoring system  
could give an inaccurate lowpressure warning if tires  
not recommended for your vehicle are installed. Tires  
that do not match the original equipment tires could  
give a lowpressure warning that is higher or lower than  
the proper warning level you would get with original  
equipment tires. See Tire Pressure Monitor System on  
page 659  
.
Your vehicle's original equipment tires are listed on the  
Tire and Loading Information Label. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 515, for more information about the  
Tire and Loading Information label and its location on  
your vehicle.  
Compact Spare Tire on page 678  
.
6-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Different Size Tires and Wheels  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
If you add wheels or tires that are a different size than  
your original equipment wheels and tires, this may  
affect the way your vehicle performs, including its  
braking, ride and handling characteristics, stability, and  
resistance to rollover. Additionally, if your vehicle has  
electronic systems such as, antilock brakes, traction  
control, and electronic stability control, the performance  
of these systems can be affected.  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on  
the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and  
maximum selection width. For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
The following information relates to the system  
developed by the Unites States National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), which  
grades tires by treadwear, traction, and  
temperature performance. This applies only to  
vehicles sold in the United States. The grades are  
molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car  
tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG)  
system does not apply to deep tread, winter-type  
snow tires, space-saver, or temporary use spare  
tires, tires with nominal rim diameters of  
WARNING:  
{
If you add different sized wheels, your vehicle  
may not provide an acceptable level of  
performance and safety if tires not recommended  
for those wheels are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and suffer serious  
injury. Only use GM specific wheel and tire  
systems developed for your vehicle, and have  
them properly installed by a GM certified  
technician.  
10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some  
limited-production tires.  
While the tires available on General Motors  
passenger cars and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they must also conform  
to federal safety requirements.  
See Buying New Tires on page 664 and Accessories  
and Modifications on page 64 for additional  
information.  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to Federal  
Safety Requirements In Addition To These  
Grades.  
6-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Treadwear  
Temperature A, B, C  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating  
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and a half (1½) times  
as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires  
depends upon the actual conditions of their use,  
however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics  
and climate.  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,  
and C, representing the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained  
high temperature can cause the material of the  
tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and  
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all passenger car tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent  
higher levels of performance on the laboratory  
test wheel than the minimum required by law.  
Warning: The temperature grade for this tire is  
established for a tire that is properly inflated and  
not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation,  
or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible  
tire failure.  
Traction AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are  
AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the  
tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as  
measured under controlled conditions on  
specified government test surfaces of asphalt and  
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance. Warning: The traction grade  
assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead  
braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
6-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Each new wheel should have the same load-carrying  
capacity, diameter, width, offset, and be mounted the  
same way as the one it replaces.  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance  
The tires and wheels on your vehicle were aligned and  
balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest  
tire life and best overall performance. Adjustments  
to wheel alignment and tire balancing will not be  
necessary on a regular basis. However, if you notice  
unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling to one side or  
the other, the alignment might need to be checked.  
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a  
smooth road, the tires and wheels might need to be  
rebalanced. See your dealer/retailer for proper  
diagnosis.  
If you need to replace any of your wheels, wheel bolts,  
wheel nuts, or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors, replace them only with new GM original  
equipment parts. This way, you will be sure to have the  
right wheel, wheel bolts, wheel nuts, and TPMS sensors  
for your vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Using the wrong replacement wheels, wheel bolts,  
or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous.  
It could affect the braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air and make you  
lose control. You could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured. Always use the  
correct wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked, or badly  
rusted or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose,  
the wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts should be  
replaced. If the wheel leaks air, replace it (except some  
aluminum wheels, which can sometimes be repaired).  
See your dealer/retailer if any of these conditions exist.  
Your dealer/retailer will know the kind of wheel  
you need.  
6-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: The wrong wheel can also cause problems  
with bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or  
odometer calibration, headlamp aim, bumper height,  
vehicle ground clearance, and tire or tire chain  
clearance to the body and chassis.  
Drive slowly and follow the chain manufacturer's  
instructions. If youcan hear the chains contacting  
your vehicle, stop and retighten them. If the  
contactcontinues, slow down until it stops. Driving  
too fast or spinning the wheels withchains on will  
damage your vehicle.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 670 for more  
information.  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
Used Replacement Wheels  
It is unusual for a tire to blowout while you are driving,  
especially if you maintain your vehicle's tires properly.  
If air goes out of a tire, it is much more likely to leak out  
slowly. But if you should ever have a blowout, here are  
a few tips about what to expect and what to do:  
WARNING:  
{
Putting a used wheel on the vehicle is dangerous.  
You cannot know how it has been used or how  
far it has been driven. It could fail suddenly and  
cause a crash. If you have to replace a wheel,  
use a new GM original equipment wheel.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire creates a drag that pulls  
the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly.  
Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake  
to a stop well out of the traffic lane.  
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts much  
like a skid and may require the same correction  
you would use in a skid. In any rear blowout  
remove your foot from the accelerator pedal.  
Tire Chains  
Notice: Use tire chains only where legal and  
only when you must. Use only SAE ClassS”  
type chains that are the proper size for your tires.  
Install themon the front tires and tighten them as  
tightly as possible with the ends securelyfastened.  
6-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Get the vehicle under control by steering the way you  
want the vehicle to go. It may be very bumpy and noisy,  
but you can still steer. Gently brake to a stop, well off  
the road if possible.  
WARNING:  
{
Changing a tire can be dangerous. The vehicle  
can slip off the jack and roll over or fall on you or  
other people. You and they could be badly injured  
or even killed. Find a level place to change your  
tire. To help prevent the vehicle from moving:  
WARNING:  
{
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do  
maintenance or repairs is dangerous without the  
appropriate safety equipment and training. If a  
jack is provided with the vehicle, it is designed  
only for changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could be badly  
injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack.  
If a jack is provided with the vehicle, only use it  
for changing a flat tire.  
1. Set the parking brake firmly.  
2. Put an automatic transmission shift lever in  
P (Park), or shift a manual transmission to  
1 (First) or R (Reverse).  
3. Turn off the engine and do not restart while  
the vehicle is raised.  
4. Do not allow passengers to remain in the  
vehicle.  
If a tire goes flat, the next part shows how to use the  
jacking equipment to change a flat tire safely.  
To be even more certain the vehicle will not move,  
you should put blocks at the front and rear of the  
tire farthest away from the one being changed.  
That would be the tire on the other side, at the  
opposite end of the vehicle.  
Changing a Flat Tire  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers on  
page 43  
.
6-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle has a flat tire (B), use the following  
example as a guide to assist you in the placement of  
wheel blocks (A).  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools  
The compact spare tire and tools you will need are  
located in the trunk.  
A. Wheel Block  
B. Flat Tire  
A. Jack  
C. Jack Handle  
B. Wheel Wrench D. Screwdriver (if equipped)  
The following information explains how to use the jack  
and change a tire.  
1. Open the trunk or liftgate. See Trunk on page 38  
or Liftgate (Hatchback) on page 310.  
2. Lift the trim cover.  
6-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Remove the foam tray.  
5. Turn the retainer counterclockwise and remove it  
from the compact spare.  
4. Remove the jack, the jack handle and the wheel  
wrench from the foam tray.  
6. Remove the compact spare tire. See Compact  
Spare Tire on page 678 for more information.  
6-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing  
the Spare Tire  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 670.  
2. If your vehicle has wheel covers, turn the four  
plastic caps counterclockwise by hand or by using  
the wheel wrench. The plastic nuts do not come off  
of the cover.  
3. Remove the wheel cover using the flat end of the  
jack handle. Pry along the edge of the wheel cover  
until it comes off.  
Store the wheel cover in the cargo area until you  
have the flat tire repaired or replaced.  
4. Turn the wheel nuts counterclockwise to loosen  
them. Do not remove them yet.  
6-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hatchback  
Sedan  
5. Locate the notch in the frame near each wheel  
which the jack head fits in.  
6. Position the jack and raise the jack head until it fits  
firmly into the notch in the vehicle's frame nearest  
the flat tire.  
7. Put the compact spare tire near you.  
6-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
8. Insert the jack handle into the jack and the wheel  
wrench onto the end of the jack handle.  
9. Turn the wheel wrench clockwise to raise the  
vehicle. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit underneath the wheel well.  
6-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10. Turn the wheel nuts counterclockwise to  
remove them.  
12. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces and  
spare wheel.  
11. Remove the flat tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or  
a paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all  
the rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
13. Place the compact spare tire on the  
wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING:  
{
page 670  
.
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
6-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14. Install the wheel nuts with the rounded end of the  
nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by hand  
clockwise until the wheel is held against the hub.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead  
to brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid  
expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the  
wheel nuts in the proper sequence and to the  
proper torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 693 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
15. Lower the vehicle by turning the wheel wrench  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
WARNING:  
{
16. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
sequence, as shown.  
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become  
loose or come off. The wheel nuts should be  
tightened with a torque wrench to the proper  
torque specification after replacing. Follow the  
torque specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 693 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
Notice: Wheel covers will not fit on your vehicle's  
compact spare. If you try to put a wheel cover on  
the compact spare, the cover or the spare could be  
damaged.  
6-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and  
Tools  
Compact Spare Tire  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Driving with more than one compact spare tire at  
a time could result in loss of braking and handling.  
This could lead to a crash and you or others could  
be injured. Use only one compact spare tire at  
a time.  
Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment in the  
passenger compartment of the vehicle could  
cause injury. In a sudden stop or collision, loose  
equipment could strike someone. Store all these  
in the proper place.  
The compact spare tire was fully inflated when the  
vehicle was new, it can lose air after a time. Check  
the inflation pressure regularly. It should be 60 psi  
(414 kPa).  
To store a flat or compact spare tire and tools:  
1. Store the flat tire or the compact spare in the  
compact spare tire compartment.  
After installing the compact spare on your vehicle, you  
should stop as soon as possible and make sure your  
spare tire is correctly inflated. The compact spare is  
intended to perform well at speeds up to 50 mph  
(80 km/h), so you can finish your trip and have your  
full-size tire repaired or replaced where you want.  
Replace your spare with a full-size tire as soon as  
you can.  
2. Secure the retainer.  
3. Store the tools securely in the foam tray and place  
the tray back in the cargo area.  
4. Replace the trim cover.  
The compact spare tire is for temporary use only.  
Replace the compact spare tire with a full-size tire  
as soon as you can. See Compact Spare Tire on  
page 678  
.
6-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: When the compact spare is installed, do not  
take the vehicle through an automatic car wash with  
guide rails. The compact spare can get caught on  
the rails which can damage the tire, wheel and other  
parts of the vehicle.  
Lighter colored interiors may require more frequent  
cleaning. Use care because newspapers and garments  
that transfer color to home furnishings may also transfer  
color to the vehicle's interior.  
When cleaning the vehicle's interior, only use cleaners  
specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned.  
Permanent damage may result from using cleaners  
on surfaces for which they were not intended. Use  
glass cleaner only on glass. Remove any accidental  
over-spray from other surfaces immediately. To prevent  
over-spray, apply cleaner directly to the cleaning cloth.  
Do not use your compact spare on other vehicles.  
Do not mix your compact spare tire or wheel with other  
wheels or tires. Keep your spare tire and its wheel  
together.  
Notice: Tire chains will not fit the compact spare.  
Using them can damage the vehicle and can  
damage the chains too. Do not use tire chains on  
the compact spare.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners when cleaning  
glass surfaces on the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the rear window  
defogger. When cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner.  
Appearance Care  
Many cleaners contain solvents that may become  
concentrated in the vehicle's breathing space.  
Before using cleaners, read and adhere to all safety  
instructions on the label. While cleaning the vehicle's  
interior, maintain adequate ventilation by opening the  
vehicle's doors and windows.  
Interior Cleaning  
The vehicle's interior will continue to look its best if  
it is cleaned often. Although not always visible, dust  
and dirt can accumulate on the upholstery. Dirt can  
damage carpet, fabric, leather, and plastic surfaces.  
Regular vacuuming is recommended to remove  
particles from the upholstery. It is important to keep  
the upholstery from becoming and remaining heavily  
soiled. Soils should be removed as quickly as possible.  
The vehicle's interior may experience extremes of heat  
that could cause stains to set rapidly.  
Dust may be removed from small buttons and knobs  
using a small brush with soft bristles.  
6-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Products that remove odors from the vehicle's  
upholstery and clean the vehicle's glass can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Fabric/Carpet  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush attachment  
frequently to remove dust and loose dirt. A canister  
vacuum with a beater bar in the nozzle may only be  
used on floor carpet and carpeted floor mats. For any  
soil, always try to remove it first with plain water or club  
soda. Before cleaning, gently remove as much of the  
soil as possible using one of the following techniques:  
Do not clean the vehicle using:  
.
A knife or any other sharp object to remove a soil  
from any interior surface.  
.
A stiff brush. It can cause damage to the vehicle's  
interior surfaces.  
.
For liquids: gently blot the remaining soil with a  
.
Heavy pressure or aggressive rubbing with a  
paper towel. Allow the soil to absorb into the paper  
towel until no more can be removed.  
cleaning cloth. Use of heavy pressure can damage  
the interior and does not improve the effectiveness  
of soil removal.  
.
For solid dry soils: remove as much as possible  
and then vacuum.  
.
Laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with  
degreasers can leave residue that streaks and  
attracts dirt. For liquid cleaners, about 20 drops per  
gallon (3.78 L) of water is a good guide. Use only  
mild, neutral-pH soaps.  
To clean:  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white cloth with water or  
club soda.  
2. Wring the cloth to remove excess moisture.  
.
Too much cleaner that saturates the upholstery.  
3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub  
toward the center. Continue cleaning, using a clean  
area of the cloth each time it becomes soiled.  
.
Organic solvents such as naptha, alcohol, etc. that  
can damage the vehicle's interior.  
4. Continue to gently rub the soiled area until the  
cleaning cloth remains clean.  
5. If the soil is not completely removed, use a mild  
soap solution and repeat the cleaning process that  
was used with plain water.  
6-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If any of the soil remains, a commercial fabric cleaner  
or spot lifter may be necessary. When a commercial  
upholstery cleaner or spot lifter is to be used, test a  
small hidden area for colorfastness first. If the locally  
cleaned area gives any impression that a ring formation  
may result, clean the entire surface.  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other  
Plastic Surfaces  
A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a clean soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove dust and dirt. Never  
use spot lifters or removers on plastic surfaces. Many  
commercial cleaners and coatings that are sold to  
preserve and protect soft plastic surfaces may  
permanently change the appearance and feel of the  
interior and are not recommended. Do not use silicone  
or wax-based products, or those containing organic  
solvents to clean the vehicle's interior because they  
can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in a  
non-uniform manner.  
After the cleaning process has been completed, a paper  
towel can be used to blot excess moisture from the  
fabric or carpet.  
Leather  
A soft cloth dampened with water can be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can  
be used. Allow the leather to dry naturally. Do not use  
heat to dry. Never use steam to clean leather. Never  
use spot lifters or spot removers on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners and coatings that are  
sold to preserve and protect leather may permanently  
change the appearance and feel of the leather and are  
not recommended. Do not use silicone or wax-based  
products, or those containing organic solvents to  
clean the vehicle's interior because they can alter the  
appearance by increasing the gloss in a non-uniform  
manner. Never use shoe polish on leather.  
Some commercial products may increase gloss on the  
instrument panel. The increase in gloss may cause  
annoying reflections in the windshield and even make  
it difficult to see through the windshield under certain  
conditions.  
6-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. Use a car  
washing soap. Do not use cleaning agents that are  
petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives, as  
they can damage the paint, metal or plastic on the  
vehicle. Approved cleaning products can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer. Follow all manufacturers'  
directions regarding correct product usage, necessary  
safety precautions and appropriate disposal of any  
vehicle care product.  
Care of Safety Belts  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not bleach or dye safety belts. It may severely  
weaken them. In a crash, they might not be able  
to provide adequate protection. Clean safety belts  
only with mild soap and lukewarm water.  
Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and after to  
remove all cleaning agents completely. If they are  
allowed to dry on the surface, they could stain.  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or an all-cotton  
towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting.  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Apply  
silicone grease with a clean cloth. During very cold,  
damp weather frequent application may be required.  
High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the  
vehicle. Avoid using high pressure washes closer than  
12 inches (30 cm) to the surface of the vehicle. Use of  
power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274 kPa) can  
result in damage or removal of paint and decals.  
Washing Your Vehicle  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a  
car washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses.  
Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on  
The best way to preserve the vehicle's finish is to keep  
it clean by washing it often.  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain chemicals that can  
damage the emblems or nameplates on the vehicle.  
Check the cleaning product label. If it states that it  
should not be used on plastic parts, do not use it on  
the vehicle or damage may occur and it would not  
be covered by the warranty.  
page 682  
.
6-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Parts  
Finish Care  
Bright metal parts should be cleaned regularly to keep  
their luster. Washing with water is all that is usually  
needed. However, chrome polish may be used on  
chrome or stainless steel trim, if necessary.  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by  
hand may be necessary to remove residue from the  
paint finish. Approved cleaning products can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Use special care with aluminum trim. To avoid  
damaging protective trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap to clean aluminum.  
A coating of wax, rubbed to high polish, is  
recommended for all bright metal parts.  
If the vehicle has a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish, the  
clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored  
basecoat. Always use waxes and polishes that are  
non-abrasive and made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint  
finish.  
Notice: Machine compounding or aggressive  
polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish  
may damage it. Use only non-abrasive waxes and  
polishes that are made for a basecoat/clearcoat  
paint finish on the vehicle.  
Windshield and Wiper Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield with glass cleaner.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper  
towel soaked with windshield washer fluid or a mild  
detergent. Wash the windshield thoroughly when  
cleaning the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a  
buildup of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause  
wiper streaking. Replace the wiper blades if they are  
worn or damaged.  
Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other  
salts, ice melting agents, road oil and tar, tree sap, bird  
droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle's finish if they remain on painted  
surfaces. Wash the vehicle as soon as possible.  
If necessary, use non-abrasive cleaners that are  
marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign  
matter.  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
.
Extreme dusty conditions  
.
Sand and salt  
Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging, weather  
and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period  
of years. To help keep the paint finish looking new, keep  
the vehicle garaged or covered whenever possible.  
.
.
Heat and sun  
Snow and ice, without proper removal  
6-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle through an automatic  
car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning  
brushes, could damage the aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never drive a  
vehicle that has aluminum or chrome-plated wheels  
through an automatic car wash that uses silicone  
carbide tire cleaning brushes.  
Aluminum Wheels  
Notice: Using strong soaps, chemicals, abrasive  
polishes, cleaners, brushes, or cleaners that contain  
acid on aluminum or chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the wheel(s). The repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Use only approved cleaners on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
Tires  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild  
soap and water. Rinse with clean water. After rinsing  
thoroughly, dry with a soft clean towel. A wax may then  
be applied.  
To clean the tires, use a stiff brush with tire cleaner.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based tire dressing  
products on the vehicle may damage the paint finish  
and/or tires. When applying a tire dressing, always  
wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on  
the vehicle.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels  
could damage the wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Use chrome polish  
on chrome wheels only.  
The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted  
surface of the vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes, abrasive cleaners,  
cleaners with acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes on  
them because the surface could be damaged. Do not  
use chrome polish on aluminum wheels.  
Sheet Metal Damage  
If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal  
repair or replacement, make sure the body repair shop  
applies anti-corrosion material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion protection.  
Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide the  
corrosion protection while maintaining the vehicle  
warranty.  
6-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
At least every spring, flush these materials from the  
underbody with plain water. Clean any areas where  
mud and debris can collect. Dirt packed in close areas  
of the frame should be loosened before being flushed.  
Your dealer/retailer or an underbody car washing  
system can do this.  
Finish Damage  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep scratches in the  
finish should be repaired right away. Bare metal will  
corrode quickly and may develop into major repair  
expense.  
Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with  
touch-up materials available from your dealer/retailer.  
Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in your  
dealer's/retailer's body and paint shop.  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a  
chemical fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall upon and  
attack painted surfaces on the vehicle. This damage  
can take two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped discolorations,  
and small, irregular dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Underbody Maintenance  
Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust  
control can collect on the underbody. If these are not  
removed, corrosion and rust can develop on the  
underbody parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan,  
and exhaust system even though they have corrosion  
protection.  
Although no defect in the paint job causes this, we will  
repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new  
vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20 000 km) of purchase,  
whichever occurs first.  
6-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service Parts Identification Label  
This label, on the inside of the glove box, has the  
following information:  
Vehicle Identification  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
.
Model designation  
.
Paint information  
.
Production options and special equipment  
Do not remove this label from the vehicle.  
Electrical System  
This legal identifier is in the front corner of the  
instrument panel, on the driver side. It can be seen  
through the windshield from outside. The VIN also  
appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts  
labels and certificates of title and registration.  
Add-On Electrical Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything electrical to the vehicle  
unless you check with your dealer/retailer first.  
Some electrical equipment can damage the vehicle  
and the damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle's warranty. Some add-on electrical  
equipment can keep other components from  
working as they should.  
Engine Identification  
The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code.  
This code identifies the vehicle's engine, specifications,  
and replacement parts. See Engine Specifications”  
under Capacities and Specifications on page 693 for  
the vehicle's engine code.  
Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle battery, even if  
the vehicle is not operating.  
6-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to  
add anything electrical to the vehicle, see Servicing  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 270 and  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
Power Windows and Other Power  
Options  
Circuit breakers in the fuse block protect the power  
windows and other power accessories. When the  
current load is too heavy, the circuit breaker opens and  
closes, protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed or  
goes away.  
page 271  
.
Headlamp Wiring  
The headlamp wiring is protected by fuses in the fuse  
block. An electrical overload will cause the lamps to turn  
off. If this happens, have the headlamp wiring checked  
right away.  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers  
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are protected from  
short circuits by a combination of fuses, circuit breakers  
and fusible thermal links. This greatly reduces the  
chance of fires caused by electrical problems.  
Windshield Wiper Fuses  
The windshield wiper motor is protected by a circuit  
breaker and a fuse. If the motor overheats due to heavy  
snow, etc., the wiper will stop until the motor cools.  
If the overload is caused by some electrical problem,  
have it fixed.  
Look at the silver-colored band inside the fuse. If the  
band is broken or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure you  
replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size  
and rating.  
Fuses of the same amperage can be temporarily  
borrowed from another fuse location, if a fuse goes out.  
Replace the fuse as soon as you can.  
6-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block  
The instrument panel fuse block is located on the end of  
the instrument panel on the driver side of the vehicle.  
Fuses  
Usage  
To access the fuses, open the fuse panel door by  
pulling the door out.  
AUDIO  
Audio, Clock, Immobilizer  
A/C Switch, Clock, Power Mirror Unit,  
Audio, Anti-Theft Module, TPMS  
AUDIO/RKE  
To reinstall the door, first insert the rear edge of the fuse  
panel door, then push the front of the door into the end  
of the instrument panel to secure it.  
B/UP LAMP  
BLANK  
PNP Switch, Reverse Lamp Switch  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Not Used  
Cigar Lighter  
BLANK  
BLANK  
CIGAR  
6-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
SOKET  
Usage  
Brake Switch, TPMS, AntiTheft  
Power Jack  
CLUSTER  
Module  
STOP LAMP  
SUNROOF  
T/SIG  
Brake Switch  
DEFOG  
MIRROR  
Sunroof Module (Option)  
Hazard Switch  
Power Mirror Unit, A/C Switch  
Rear Defog  
RR DEFOG  
WIPER  
Wiper Switch, Wiper Motor  
DOOR LOCK Door Lock  
NA DRL  
NA DRL Circuit  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block  
MIRROR/  
SUNROOF  
Mirror Control Switch, Room Lamp,  
A/C Switch  
The engine compartment fuse block is located on the  
driver side of the vehicle, near the battery. See Engine  
Compartment Overview on page 614 for more  
information on location.  
Engine Room Fuse Block, TCM, VSS,  
Fuel Pump  
EMS 1  
EMS 2  
HORN  
Stoplamp Switch  
Horn  
Notice: Spilling liquid on any electrical components  
on the vehicle may damage it. Always keep the  
covers on any electrical component.  
OBD  
DLC, Immobilizer  
Trunk Room Lamp, Trunk Open  
To access the fuses, press in the side flaps to release  
the cover. To reinstall the cover, push the cover until it is  
secure.  
CLUSTER/  
ROOM LAMP Switch, IPC, Room Lamp  
SDM Sensing and Diagnostic Module  
6-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
FAN HI  
ABS1  
ABS2  
Usage  
Cooling Fan HI Relay  
EBCM  
Fuses  
SJB BATT  
ACC/IG1  
IG2/ST  
Usage  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block  
IGN1 Relay  
EBCM  
IGN2 Relay, Starter Relay  
6-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
HAZARD  
HDLP HI LH  
HDLP HI RH  
IPC  
Usage  
Hazard Switch, Hood Contact Switch  
Head Lamp (LH), IPC  
Head Lamp (RH)  
ACC/RAP  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block  
P/WINDOW2 Power Window Switch  
P/W WINDOW1 Power Window Switch  
FAN LOW  
A/CON  
Cooling Fan LOW Relay  
A/C Compressor Relay  
IPC  
HDLP LO LH Head Lamp (LH), I/P Fuse Block  
HDLP LO RH Head Lamp (RH)  
Tail Lamp (LH), Side Marker (LH),  
Turn Signal & Parking Lamp (LH),  
License Lamp  
PKLP LH  
PKLP RH  
EMS1  
ECM, Injector  
Ignition Switch  
DLIS  
Tail Lamp (RH), Side Marker (RH),  
Turn Signal & Parking Lamp (RH),  
License Lamp, I/P Fuse Block  
EVAP Canister Purge Solenoid,  
Thermostat Heater, HO2S, MAF  
Sensor  
EMS2  
ECU  
ECM, TCM  
SPARE  
Not Used  
FRT FOG  
F/PUMP  
Front Fog Lamp Relay  
Fuel Pump Relay  
6-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relays  
Usage  
Relays  
Usage  
Cooling Fan Low  
F/PUMP RELAY Fuel Pump  
FAN LOW  
RELAY  
STARTER  
Starter  
RELAY  
A/CON RELAY Air Conditioner  
PARK LAMP  
Park Lamp  
RELAY  
ENGINE MAIN  
Main Power  
RELAY  
FRONT FOG  
Fog Lamp  
RELAY  
ACC/RAP  
I/P Fuse Block  
RELAY  
HDLP HIGH  
RELAY  
IGN2 RELAY Ignition  
Head Lamp High  
Head Lamp Low  
Cooling Fan High  
HDLP LOW  
RELAY  
Misc.  
Usage  
FUSE PULLER Fuse Puller  
FAN HIGH  
RELAY  
6-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Capacities and Specifications  
The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions. See Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants on page 711 for more information.  
Capacities  
Application  
English  
Metric  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant caution label located  
under the hood. See your dealer/retailer for more  
information.  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a  
Cooling System  
6.7 qt  
4.8 qt  
6.3 L  
4.5 L  
Engine Oil with Filter  
Fuel Tank  
11.9 gal  
6.2 qt  
45.0 L  
5.87 L  
1.8 L  
Transmission, Automatic  
Transmission, Manual  
Wheel Nut Torque  
1.9 qt  
81 lb ft  
110 Y  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this manual.  
Recheck fluid level after filling.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Spark Plug Gap  
Automatic and  
Manual  
1.6L L4  
6
0.039-0.043 inch (1.0-1.1 mm)  
6-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
6-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7 Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The maintenance schedule is for vehicles that:  
Maintenance Schedule  
.
carry passengers and cargo within recommended  
limits on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 515.  
Introduction  
Notice: Maintenance intervals, checks, inspections,  
recommended fluids, and lubricants are necessary  
to keep this vehicle in good working condition.  
Damage caused by failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
.
are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal  
driving limits.  
.
use the recommended fuel. See Gasoline Octane  
on page 66  
.
As the vehicle owner, you are responsible for the  
scheduled maintenance in this section. We recommend  
having your dealer/retailer perform these services.  
Proper vehicle maintenance helps to keep the vehicle  
in good working condition, improves fuel economy, and  
reduces vehicle emissions for better air quality.  
WARNING:  
{
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be  
dangerous. In trying to do some jobs, you can be  
seriously injured. Do your own maintenance work  
only if you have the required know-how and the  
proper tools and equipment for the job. If you  
have any doubt, see your dealer/retailer to have a  
qualified technician do the work. See Doing Your  
Own Service Work on page 65.  
Because of all the different ways people use vehicles,  
maintenance needs vary. The vehicle might need  
more frequent checks and services. Please read the  
information under Scheduled Maintenance. To keep  
the vehicle in good condition, see your dealer/retailer.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
At your dealer/retailer, you can be certain that you will  
receive the highest level of service available. Your  
dealer/retailer has specially trained service technicians,  
uses genuine replacement parts, as well as, up to date  
tools and equipment to ensure fast and accurate  
diagnostics.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
When the Change Engine Oil Light  
Displays  
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
page 615. An Emission Control Service.  
The proper replacement parts, fluids, and lubricants to  
use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
on page 711 and Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 713. We recommend the use of genuine parts  
from your dealer/retailer.  
When the change engine oil light displays, service is  
required for the vehicle as soon as possible, within  
the next 1 000 km/600 miles. If driving under the best  
conditions, the engine oil life system might not indicate  
the need for vehicle service for more than a year.  
The engine oil and filter must be changed at least  
once a year and the oil life system must be reset.  
Your dealer/retailer has trained service technicians  
who will perform this work and reset the system. If the  
engine oil life system is reset accidentally, service the  
vehicle within 5 000 km/3,000 miles since the last  
service. Reset the oil life system whenever the oil is  
changed. See Engine Oil Life System on page 618.  
Rotation of New Tires  
To maintain ride, handling, and performance of the  
vehicle, it is important that the first rotation service for  
new tires be performed when they have 8 000 to  
13 000 km (5,000 to 8,000 miles). See Tire Inspection  
and Rotation on page 662.  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Fluids visual leak check (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first). A leak in any system must  
be repaired and the fluid level checked.  
When the change engine oil light displays, certain  
services, checks, and inspections are required.  
The services described for Maintenance I should  
be performed at every engine oil change. The  
services described for Maintenance II should be  
performed when:  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles  
driven in dusty conditions only). See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
.
Maintenance I was performed the last time the  
Brake system inspection (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first).  
engine oil was changed.  
.
It has been 10 months or more since the change  
Maintenance II  
engine oil light has displayed or since the last  
service.  
.
Perform all services described in Maintenance I.  
.
Steering and suspension inspection. Visual  
inspection for damaged, loose, or missing parts  
or signs of wear.  
Maintenance I  
.
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
page 615. An Emission Control Service.  
.
Engine cooling system inspection. Visual  
inspection of hoses, pipes, fittings, and clamps  
and replacement, if needed.  
.
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 625  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 633.  
Windshield wiper blade inspection for wear,  
cracking, or contamination and windshield and  
wiper blade cleaning, if contaminated. See  
Windshield and Wiper Blades on page 683  
Worn or damaged wiper blade replacement.  
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
.
on page 658  
.
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 662.  
See Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
page 650  
.
Rotate tires. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 662  
.
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
Body hinges and latches, key lock cylinders,  
and trunk lid hinges and latches lubrication.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 711. More frequent lubrication may be  
required when vehicle is exposed to a corrosive  
environment. Applying silicone grease on  
weatherstrips with a clean cloth makes them  
last longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.  
PCV system inspection. An Emission Control  
Service. The U.S. Environmental Protection  
Agency or the California Air Resources Board  
has determined that the failure to perform this  
maintenance item will not nullify the emission  
warranty or limit recall liability prior to the  
completion of the vehicle's useful life.  
We, however, urge that all recommended  
maintenance services be performed at the  
indicated intervals and the maintenance be  
recorded.  
.
.
Restraint system component check. See Checking  
the Restraint Systems on page 272.  
Automatic transmission fluid level check  
and adding fluid, if needed. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on page 620.  
Additional Required Services  
At Each Fuel Stop  
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter inspection. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
.
Engine oil level check. See Engine Oil on  
page 615  
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 625  
.
Passenger compartment air filter (if equipped)  
replacement (or every 12 months, whichever  
occurs first). More frequent replacement may be  
required if vehicle is driven regularly under dusty  
conditions.  
.
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check.  
See Windshield Washer Fluid on page 633.  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Once a Month  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
40 000 km/25,000 Miles  
.
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
on page 658  
.
.
Fuel system inspection for damage or leaks.  
.
.
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 662.  
Engine air cleaner filter replacement. See Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter on page 619.  
.
Spark plug replacement. Not to exceed  
60 000 km/37,500 miles). An Emission Control  
Service.  
Once a Year  
.
Starter switch check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 79.  
.
Engine accessory drive belt inspection for fraying,  
.
.
Parking brake and automatic transmission P (Park)  
mechanism check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 79.  
excessive cracks, or obvious damage and  
replacement, if needed. An Emission Control  
Service.  
Automatic transmission shiftlock control system  
.
Exhaust system and nearby heat shields  
inspection for loose or damaged components.  
check. See Owner Checks and Services on  
page 79  
.
.
.
Ignition transmission lock check. See Owner  
Checks and Services on page 79.  
Engine cooling system and pressure cap pressure  
check. Radiator and air conditioning condenser  
outside cleaning. See Cooling System on  
page 624  
.
.
Accelerator pedal check for damage, high effort,  
or binding. Replace if needed.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
80 000 km/50,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
160 000 km/100,000 Miles  
.
.
Automatic transmission fluid and filter change  
Timing belt replacement.  
(severe service only) for vehicles mainly driven  
in heavy city traffic in hot weather, in hilly or  
mountainous terrain, when frequently towing a  
trailer, or used for taxi, police, or delivery service.  
See Automatic Transmission Fluid on page 620.  
.
Valve clearance adjustment.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
240 000 km/150,000 Miles  
.
Engine cooling system drain, flush, and refill,  
.
Power steering pump accessory drive belt  
replacement.  
cooling system and cap pressure check, and  
cleaning of outside of radiator and air conditioning  
condenser (or every 5 years, whichever occurs  
first). See Engine Coolant on page 625. An  
Emission Control Service.  
.
Evaporative control system inspection. Check all  
fuel and vapor lines and hoses for proper hookup,  
routing, and condition. EVAP vent solenoid valve  
replacement. An Emission Control Service.  
The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the  
California Air Resources Board has determined  
that the failure to perform this maintenance item  
will not nullify the emission warranty or limit  
recall liability prior to the completion of the  
vehicle's useful life. We, however, urge that all  
recommended maintenance services be performed  
at the indicated intervals and the maintenance be  
recorded.  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Service  
Maintenance I Maintenance II  
Change engine oil and filter. Reset oil life system.  
Engine coolant level check.  
Windshield washer fluid level check.  
Tire inflation pressures check.  
Tire wear inspection.  
Rotate tires.  
Fluids visual leak check.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles driven in dusty conditions only).  
Brake system inspection.  
Steering and suspension inspection.  
Engine cooling system inspection.  
Windshield wiper blades inspection.  
Body components lubrication.  
Restraint system components check.  
Automatic transmission fluid level check.  
Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles not driven in dusty conditions).  
Passenger compartment air filter (if equipped) replacement.  
PCV system inspection.  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. For automatic transmission vehicles, try to start the  
engine in each gear. The starter should work only  
in P (Park) or N (Neutral). If the starter works in any  
other position, your vehicle needs service.  
Owner Checks and Services  
Starter Switch Check  
For manual transmission vehicles, put the shift  
lever in Neutral, push the clutch pedal down  
halfway, and try to start the engine. The starter  
should work only when the clutch pedal is pushed  
down all the way to the floor. If the starter works  
when the clutch pedal is not pushed all the way  
down, your vehicle needs service.  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle.  
2. Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 328.  
Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be ready to  
turn off the engine immediately if it starts.  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock  
Control System Check  
Ignition Transmission Lock Check  
While parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn  
the ignition to LOCK/OFF in each shift lever position.  
.
For automatic transmission vehicles, the ignition  
should turn to LOCK/OFF only when the shift lever  
is in P (Park).  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
.
For manual transmission vehicles, the ignition  
should turn to LOCK/OFF only when you press the  
key release button.  
On all vehicles, the ignition key should come out only in  
LOCK/OFF.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle. It should be parked on a  
level surface.  
Turn the steering wheel to the left and to the right.  
It should only lock when turned to the right.  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake. See Parking Brake  
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
on page 328  
.
Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if  
the vehicle begins to move.  
3. With the engine off, turn the ignition to ON/RUN,  
but do not start the engine. Without applying the  
regular brake, try to move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the shift lever moves  
out of P (Park), contact your dealer/retailer for  
service.  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking Brake and Automatic  
Transmission P (Park) Mechanism  
Check  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants  
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name, part  
number, or specification can be obtained from your  
dealer/retailer.  
WARNING:  
{
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Engine oil which meets GM Standard  
GM6094M and displays the American  
Petroleum Institute Certified for  
Gasoline Engines starburst symbol.  
To determine the proper viscosity for  
your vehicle's engine, see Engine Oil  
When you are doing this check, the vehicle could  
begin to move. You or others could be injured and  
property could be damaged. Make sure there is  
room in front of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular brake at once  
should the vehicle begin to move.  
Engine Oil  
on page 615  
.
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
water and use only DEX-COOL®  
Coolant. See Engine Coolant on  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing  
downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set  
the parking brake.  
Engine Coolant  
page 625  
.
.
To check the parking brake's holding ability:  
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377967,  
in Canada 89021320).  
Hydraulic Brake  
System  
With the engine running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot pressure from the  
regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held  
by the parking brake only.  
Windshield  
Washer Solvent  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
.
To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding ability:  
Power Steering DEXRON®VI Automatic Transmission  
System Fluid.  
With the engine running, shift to P (Park). Then  
release the parking brake followed by the regular  
brake.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Use only T-IV Automatic Transmission  
Fluid (GM Part No. U.S. 88900925,  
in Canada 22689186).  
Hood Latch  
Assembly,  
Secondary  
Automatic  
Transmission  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346293,  
Latch, Pivots, in Canada 992723) or lubricant  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 89021806,  
in Canada 89021807).  
Manual  
Transmission  
Spring  
Anchor, and  
Release Pawl  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241,  
in Canada 10953474).  
Key Lock  
Cylinders  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241,  
in Canada 10953474).  
Hood and Door  
Hinges  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985,  
Transmission in Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
Weatherstrip Lubricant  
Manual  
(GM Part No. U.S. 3634770,  
in Canada 10953518) or  
Dielectric Silicone Grease  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12345579,  
in Canada 992887).  
Weatherstrip  
Conditioning  
Shift Linkage  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985,  
in Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis  
Lubrication  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Part  
GM Part Number  
96536696  
ACDelco Part Number  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
Engine Oil Filter  
A3081C  
93185674  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
Spark Plugs  
96962173  
96476119  
Wiper Blades - Hatchback  
Driver Side  
96476652  
96476656  
96301840  
Passenger Side  
Rear  
Wiper Blades - Sedan  
Driver Side  
96476652  
96476656  
Passenger Side  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Drive Belt Routing  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 8 Customer Assistance Information  
Customer Assistance and Information . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Customer Assistance  
to the United States Government . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Reporting Safety Defects  
for Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-7  
Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
to the Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Reporting Safety Defects  
to General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 8-17  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP TWO: If after contacting a member of dealership  
management, it appears your concern cannot be  
resolved by the dealership without further help, in the  
U.S., call the Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
at 1-800-222-1020. In Canada, call General Motors  
of Canada Customer Communication Centre at  
Customer Assistance and  
Information  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure  
1-800-263-3777 (English), or 1-800-263-7854 (French).  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your  
dealer and to Chevrolet. Normally, any concerns with  
the sales transaction or the operation of the vehicle  
will be resolved by the dealer's sales or service  
departments. Sometimes, however, despite the best  
intentions of all concerned, misunderstandings can  
occur. If your concern has not been resolved to your  
satisfaction, the following steps should be taken:  
We encourage you to call the toll-free number in order  
to give your inquiry prompt attention. Have the following  
information available to give the Customer Assistance  
Representative:  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is  
available from the vehicle registration or title, or  
the plate at the top left of the instrument panel  
and visible through the windshield.  
STEP ONE: Discuss your concern with a member  
of dealership management. Normally, concerns can  
be quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has  
already been reviewed with the sales, service, or parts  
manager, contact the owner of the dealership or the  
general manager.  
.
Dealership name and location.  
.
Vehicle delivery date and present mileage.  
When contacting Chevrolet, remember that your  
concern will likely be resolved at a dealer's facility.  
That is why we suggest following Step One first.  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE U.S. Owners: Both General Motors  
and your dealer are committed to making sure you are  
completely satisfied with your new vehicle. However,  
if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the  
procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, you can file  
with the Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line  
Program to enforce your rights.  
You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the  
toll-free telephone number or write them at the following  
address:  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program  
administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus  
to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs  
or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. Although you may be required to resort to  
this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing  
a court action, use of the program is free of charge  
and your case will generally be heard within 40 days.  
If you do not agree with the decision given in your case,  
you may reject it and proceed with any other venue for  
relief available to you.  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
dr.bbb.org/goauto  
This program is available in all 50 states and the  
District of Columbia. Eligibility is limited by vehicle age,  
mileage, and other factors. General Motors reserves the  
right to change eligibility limitations and/or discontinue  
its participation in this program.  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
STEP THREE Canadian Owners: In the event  
that you do not feel your concerns have been  
For further information concerning eligibility in the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP), call  
toll-free 1-800-207-0685, or call the General Motors  
Customer Communication Centre, 1-800-263-3777  
(English), 1-800-263-7854 (French), or write to:  
addressed after following the procedure outlined  
in Steps 1 and 2, General Motors of Canada Limited  
wants you to be aware of its participation in a no-charge  
Mediation/Arbitration Program. General Motors of  
Canada Limited has committed to binding arbitration  
of owner disputes involving factory-related vehicle  
service claims. The program provides for the review  
of the facts involved by an impartial third party arbiter,  
and may include an informal hearing before the arbiter.  
The program is designed so that the entire dispute  
settlement process, from the time you file your  
complaint to the final decision, should be completed  
in about 70 days. We believe our impartial program  
offers advantages over courts in most jurisdictions  
because it is informal, quick, and free of charge.  
The Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Your inquiry should be accompanied by the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN).  
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
My GM Canada (Canada) www.gm.ca  
Online Owner Center  
My GM Canada is a password-protected section  
of www.gm.ca where you can save information on  
GM vehicles, get personalized offers, and use handy  
tools and forms with greater ease.  
Online Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
Information and services customized for your specific  
vehicle all in one convenient place.  
Here are a few of the valuable tools and services you  
will have access to:  
.
Digital owner manual, warranty information,  
.
and more  
My Showroom: Find and save information on  
vehicles and current offers in your area.  
.
Online service and maintenance records  
.
My Dealers/Retailers: Save details such as  
address and phone number for each of your  
preferred GM dealers/retailers.  
.
Find Chevrolet dealers for service nationwide  
.
Exclusive privileges and offers  
.
Recall notices for your specific vehicle  
OnStar® and GM Cardmember Services Earnings  
summaries  
.
My Driveway: Access quick links to parts  
.
and service estimates, check trade-in values,  
or schedule a service appointment by adding  
the vehicles you own to your driveway profile.  
Other Helpful Links:  
.
My Preferences: Manage your profile and use tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Chevrolet www.chevrolet.com  
Chevrolet Merchandise www.chevymall.com  
Help Center www.chevrolet.com/helpcenter  
To sign up, visit the My GM Canada section within  
www.gm.ca.  
.
FAQ  
.
Contact Us  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
From Puerto Rico:  
Customer Assistance for Text  
Telephone (TTY) Users  
1-800-496-9992 (English)  
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)  
To assist customers who are deaf, hard of  
From U.S. Virgin Islands:  
1-800-496-9994  
hearing, or speech-impaired and who use Text  
Telephones (TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY equipment  
available at its Customer Assistance Center. Any TTY  
user in the U.S. can communicate with Chevrolet by  
dialing: 1-800-833-CHEV (2438). (TTY users in Canada  
can dial 1-800-263-3830.)  
Canada Customer Assistance  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
gmcanada.com  
Customer Assistance Offices  
Chevrolet encourages customers to call the toll-free  
number for assistance. However, if a customer wishes  
to write or e-mail Chevrolet, the letter should be  
addressed to:  
1-800-263-3777 (English)  
1-800-263-7854 (French)  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-268-6800  
United States Customer Assistance  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Overseas Customer Assistance  
Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit.  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
Chevrolet.com  
1-800-222-1020  
1-800-833-2438 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-CHEV-USA (243-8872)  
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The offer is available for a very limited period of time  
from the date of vehicle purchase/lease. For more  
details, or to determine your vehicle's eligibility, visit  
gmmobility.com or call the GM Mobility Assistance  
Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text telephone (TTY) users,  
call 1-800-833-9935.  
Mexico, Central America and Caribbean  
Islands/Countries (Except Puerto Rico  
and U.S. Virgin Islands) Customer  
Assistance  
General Motors de Mexico, S. de R.L. de C.V.  
Customer Assistance Center  
Paseo de la Reforma # 2740  
Col. Lomas de Bezares  
General Motors of Canada also has a Mobility Program.  
Call 1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) for details. TTY users  
call 1-800-263-3830.  
C.P. 11910, Mexico, D.F.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
01-800-508-0000  
Long Distance: 011-52-53 29 0 800  
For U.S. purchased vehicles, call  
1800CHEVUSA (18002438872);  
(Text telephone (TTY): 18888892438).  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Program  
For Canadian purchased vehicles, call 1-800-268-6800.  
Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
Calling for Assistance  
When calling Roadside Assistance, have the following  
information ready:  
.
Your name, home address, and home telephone  
number  
.
Telephone number of your location  
This program, available to qualified applicants,  
can reimburse you up to $1,000 of the cost of  
eligible aftermarket adaptive equipment required  
for your vehicle, such as hand controls or a  
wheelchair/scooter lift.  
.
Location of the vehicle  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Model, year, color, and license plate number of  
the vehicle  
Services Provided  
.
Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of enough  
fuel for the vehicle to get to the nearest service  
station.  
Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN), and delivery date of the vehicle  
Description of the problem  
.
LockOut Service: Service is provided to unlock  
the vehicle if you are locked out. A remote unlock  
may be available if you have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must present identification  
before this service is given.  
Coverage  
Services are provided up to 5 years/100,000 miles  
(160 000 km), whichever comes first.  
.
In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is covered.  
In Canada, a person driving the vehicle without  
permission from the owner is not covered.  
Emergency Tow From a Public Road or  
Highway: Tow to the nearest Chevrolet dealer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle was in a crash  
and cannot be driven. Assistance is also given  
when the vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud,  
or snow.  
Roadside Assistance is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. Chevrolet and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to make any changes  
or discontinue the Roadside Assistance program at any  
time without notification.  
.
Flat Tire Change: Service is provided to change  
a flat tire with the spare tire. The spare tire,  
if equipped, must be in good condition and  
properly inflated. It is the owner's responsibility  
for the repair or replacement of the tire if it is not  
covered by the warranty.  
Chevrolet and General Motors of Canada Limited  
reserve the right to limit services or payment to an  
owner or driver if they decide the claims are made too  
often, or the same type of claim is made many times.  
.
Battery Jump Start: Service is provided to jump  
start a dead battery.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance: Must  
be over 250 km from where your trip was started to  
qualify. General Motors of Canada Limited requires  
pre-authorization, original detailed receipts, and a  
copy of the repair orders. Once authorization has  
been received, the Roadside Assistance advisor  
will help you make arrangements and explain how  
to receive payment.  
Services Not Included in Roadside  
Assistance  
.
.
.
Impound towing caused by violation of any laws.  
Legal fines.  
Mounting, dismounting or changing of snow tires,  
chains, or other traction devices.  
.
.
Towing or services for vehicles driven on a  
non-public road or highway.  
Alternative Service: If assistance cannot be  
provided right away, the Roadside Assistance  
advisor may give you permission to get local  
emergency road service. You will receive payment,  
up to $100, after sending the original receipt to  
Roadside Assistance. Mechanical failures may be  
covered, however any cost for parts and labor  
for repairs not covered by the warranty are the  
owner responsibility.  
Services Specific to Canadian  
Purchased Vehicles  
.
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement is approximately  
$5 Canadian. Diesel fuel delivery may be  
restricted. Propane and other fuels are not  
provided through this service.  
.
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is  
required.  
.
Trip Routing Service: Detailed maps of North  
America are provided when requested either  
with the most direct route or the most scenic  
route. There is a limit of six requests per year.  
Additional travel information is also available.  
Allow three weeks for delivery.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduling Service Appointments  
Courtesy Transportation Program  
When your vehicle requires warranty service, contact  
your dealer/retailer and request an appointment. By  
scheduling a service appointment and advising your  
service consultant of your transportation needs, your  
dealer/retailer can help minimize your inconvenience.  
To enhance your ownership experience, we and our  
participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer support program for vehicles  
with the New Vehicle Limited Warranty (Base Warranty  
Coverage period in Canada) and extended powertrain,  
and hybrid specific warranty in both the U.S. and  
Canada.  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service  
department immediately, keep driving it until it can  
be scheduled for service, unless, of course, the  
problem is safety-related. If it is, please call your  
dealership/retailer, let them know this, and ask for  
instructions.  
Several courtesy transportation options are available to  
assist in reducing your inconvenience when warranty  
repairs are required.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. A separate booklet entitled Warranty  
and Owner Assistance Informationfurnished with each  
new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
If the dealer/retailer requests you to bring the vehicle for  
service, you are urged to do so as early in the work day  
as possible to allow for the same day repair.  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
for U.S. customers, should you arrange transportation  
through a friend or relative, limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be available. Claim  
amounts should reflect actual costs and be supported  
by original receipts. See your dealer for information  
regarding the allowance amounts for reimbursement of  
fuel or other transportation costs.  
Transportation Options  
Warranty service can generally be completed  
while you wait. However, if you are unable to wait,  
GM helps to minimize your inconvenience by providing  
several transportation options. Depending on the  
circumstances, your dealer can offer you one of  
the following:  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Shuttle Service  
Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a  
courtesy rental vehicle or reimburse you for a rental  
vehicle that you obtain if your vehicle is kept for an  
overnight warranty repair. Rental reimbursement will  
be limited and must be supported by original receipts.  
This requires that you sign and complete a rental  
agreement and meet state/provincial, local, and rental  
vehicle provider requirements. Requirements vary and  
may include minimum age requirements, insurance  
coverage, credit card, etc. You are responsible for fuel  
usage charges and may also be responsible for taxes,  
levies, usage fees, excessive mileage, or rental usage  
beyond the completion of the repair.  
Shuttle service is the preferred means of offering  
Courtesy Transportation. Dealers may provide you  
with shuttle service to get you to your destination  
with minimal interruption of your daily schedule.  
This includes oneway or round trip shuttle service  
within reasonable time and distance parameters of  
the dealer's area.  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs, and  
public transportation is used instead of the dealer's  
shuttle service, the expense must be supported by  
original receipts and can only be up to the maximum  
amount allowed by GM for shuttle service. In addition,  
It may not be possible to provide a like-vehicle as a  
courtesy rental.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional Program Information  
Collision Parts  
All program options, such as shuttle service, may not  
be available at every dealer. Please contact your dealer  
for specific information about availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be administered by  
appropriate dealer personnel.  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with  
the same materials and construction methods as  
the parts with which your vehicle was originally built.  
Genuine GM Collision parts are your best choice to  
ensure that your vehicle's designed appearance,  
durability, and safety are preserved. The use of  
Genuine GM parts can help maintain your GM New  
Vehicle Warranty.  
General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify,  
change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any  
time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility  
pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein  
at its sole discretion.  
Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for  
repair. These parts are typically removed from vehicles  
that were total losses in prior crashes. In most cases,  
the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections  
of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment GM part,  
may be an acceptable choice to maintain your vehicle's  
originally designed appearance and safety performance,  
however, the history of these parts is not known. Such  
parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty, and any related failures are not covered by  
that warranty.  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a collision and it is  
damaged, have the damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper equipment and quality  
replacement parts. Poorly performed collision repairs  
diminish your vehicle's resale value, and safety  
performance can be compromised in subsequent  
collisions.  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Aftermarket collision parts are also available. These are  
made by companies other than GM and may not have  
been tested for your vehicle. As a result, these parts  
may fit poorly, exhibit premature durability/corrosion  
problems, and may not perform properly in subsequent  
collisions. Aftermarket parts are not covered by your  
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any vehicle  
failure related to such parts are not covered by that  
warranty.  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Protect your investment in your GM vehicle with  
comprehensive and collision insurance coverage.  
There are significant differences in the quality of  
coverage afforded by various insurance policy terms.  
Many insurance policies provide reduced protection to  
your GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage  
repairs by using aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not specify aftermarket  
collision parts. When purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you assure your vehicle will be  
repaired with GM original equipment collision parts.  
If such insurance coverage is not available from your  
current insurance carrier, consider switching to another  
insurance carrier.  
Repair Facility  
We recommend that you choose a collision repair  
facility that meets your needs before you ever need  
collision repairs. Your dealer/retailer may have a  
collision repair center with GM-trained technicians and  
state of the art equipment, or be able to recommend a  
collision repair center that has GM-trained technicians  
and comparable equipment.  
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing company may  
require you to have insurance that assures repairs with  
Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)  
parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts.  
Read your lease carefully, as you may be charged at  
the end of your lease for poor quality repairs.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Gather the important information you will need from  
the other driver. Things like name, address, phone  
number, driver's license number, vehicle license  
plate, vehicle make, model and model year,  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), insurance  
company and policy number, and a general  
description of the damage to the other vehicle.  
If a Crash Occurs  
Here is what to do if you are involved in a crash.  
.
Check to make sure that you are all right. If you  
are uninjured, make sure that no one else in your  
vehicle, or the other vehicle, is injured.  
.
If there has been an injury, call emergency  
.
If possible, call your insurance company from the  
scene of the crash. They will walk you through the  
information they will need. If they ask for a police  
report, phone or go to the police department  
headquarters the next day and you can get a  
copy of the report for a nominal fee. In some  
states/provinces with no faultinsurance laws, a  
report may not be necessary. This is especially  
true if there are no injuries and both vehicles  
are driveable.  
services for help. Do not leave the scene of a  
crash until all matters have been taken care of.  
Move your vehicle only if its position puts you  
in danger or you are instructed to move it by a  
police officer.  
.
Give only the necessary and requested information  
to police and other parties involved in the crash.  
Do not discuss your personal condition, mental  
frame of mind, or anything unrelated to the crash.  
This will help guard against post-crash legal action.  
.
Choose a reputable collision repair facility for  
your vehicle. Whether you select a dealer/retailer  
or a private collision repair facility to fix the  
damage, make sure you are comfortable with  
them. Remember, you will have to feel comfortable  
with their work for a long time.  
.
If you need roadside assistance, call GM Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
page 87 for more information.  
.
If your vehicle cannot be driven, know where the  
towing service will be taking it. Get a card from the  
tow truck operator or write down the driver's name,  
the service's name, and the phone number.  
.
Once you have an estimate, read it carefully and  
make sure you understand what work will be  
performed on your vehicle. If you have a question,  
ask for an explanation. Reputable shops welcome  
this opportunity.  
.
Remove any valuables from your vehicle before  
it is towed away. Make sure this includes your  
insurance information and registration if you keep  
these items in your vehicle.  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair  
Process  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
United States Government  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which  
could cause a crash or could cause injury or  
death, you should immediately inform the National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in  
addition to notifying General Motors.  
In the event that your vehicle requires damage repairs,  
GM recommends that you take an active role in its  
repair. If you have a pre-determined repair facility of  
choice, take your vehicle there, or have it towed there.  
Specify to the facility that any required replacement  
collision parts be original equipment parts, either  
new Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts.  
Remember, recycled parts will not be covered by your  
GM vehicle warranty.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open  
an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect  
exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot  
become involved in individual problems between  
you, your dealer, or General Motors.  
Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but you must  
live with the repair. Depending on your policy limits,  
your insurance company may initially value the  
repair using aftermarket parts. Discuss this with your  
repair professional, and insist on Genuine GM parts.  
Remember if your vehicle is leased you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine  
GM parts, even if your insurance coverage does not  
pay the full cost.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle  
Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236  
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to  
If another party's insurance company is paying for  
the repairs, you are not obligated to accept a repair  
valuation based on that insurance company's collision  
policy repair limits, as you have no contractual limits  
with that company. In such cases, you can have control  
of the repair and parts choices as long as cost stays  
within reasonable limits.  
http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
Administrator, NHTSA  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor  
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Canadian Government  
Reporting Safety Defects to General  
Motors  
If you live in Canada, and you believe that your  
vehicle has a safety defect, notify Transport Canada  
immediately, in addition to notifying General Motors of  
Canada Limited. Call them at 1-800-333-0510 or  
write to:  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport Canada) in  
a situation like this, please notify General Motors.  
Call 1-800-222-1020, or write:  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777 (English) or  
1-800-263-7854 (French), or write:  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Current and Past Model Order Forms  
Technical Service Bulletins and Manuals are available  
for current and past model GM vehicles. To request an  
order form, specify year and model name of the vehicle.  
Service Publications Ordering  
Information  
Service Manuals  
Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair  
information on engines, transmission, axle suspension,  
brakes, electrical, steering, body, etc.  
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-551-4123  
Monday-Friday 8:00 AM - 6:00 PM  
Eastern Time  
Service Bulletins  
For Credit Card Orders Only  
(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visit Helm, Inc. on the  
World Wide Web at: helminc.com  
Service Bulletins give additional technical service  
information needed to knowledgeably service General  
Motors cars and trucks. Each bulletin contains  
instructions to assist in the diagnosis and service of  
your vehicle.  
Or you can write to:  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
Owner Information  
Prices are subject to change without notice and without  
incurring obligation. Allow ample time for delivery.  
Owner publications are written specifically for owners  
and intended to provide basic operational information  
about the vehicle. The owner manual includes the  
Maintenance Schedule for all models.  
Note to Canadian Customers: All listed prices are  
quoted in U.S. funds. Canadian residents are to make  
checks payable in U.S. funds.  
In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio, Owner Manual, and  
Warranty Booklet.  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $35.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Without Portfolio: Owner Manual only.  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $25.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Event Data Recorders  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy  
This vehicle has an Event Data Recorder (EDR).  
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain  
crash or near crash-like situations, such as an airbag  
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will  
assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems  
performed. The EDR is designed to record data related  
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short  
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR  
in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:  
Your GM vehicle has a number of sophisticated  
computers that record information about the vehicles  
performance and how it is driven. For example, your  
vehicle uses computer modules to monitor and control  
engine and transmission performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment and deploy airbags in  
a crash and, if so equipped, to provide antilock braking  
to help the driver control the vehicle. These modules  
may store data to help your dealer/retailer technician  
service your vehicle. Some modules may also store  
data about how you operate the vehicle, such as rate  
of fuel consumption or average speed. These modules  
may also retain the owners personal preferences, such  
as radio pre-sets, seat positions, and temperature  
settings.  
.
How various systems in your vehicle were  
operating  
.
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety  
belts were buckled/fastened  
.
How far, if at all, the driver was pressing the  
accelerator and/or brake pedal  
.
How fast the vehicle was traveling  
This data can help provide a better understanding of the  
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if  
a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data is recorded  
by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no  
personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash  
location) is recorded. However, other parties, such as  
law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the  
type of personally identifying data routinely acquired  
during a crash investigation.  
GM will not access this data or share it with others  
except: with the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the  
vehicle is leased, with the consent of the lessee; in  
response to an official request of police or similar  
government office; as part of GM's defense of litigation  
through the discovery process; or, as required by law.  
Data that GM collects or receives may also be used for  
GM research needs or may be made available to others  
for research purposes, where a need is shown and the  
data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner.  
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment  
is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is  
needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other  
parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special  
equipment, can read the information if they have access  
to the vehicle or the EDR.  
OnStar®  
If your vehicle has OnStar and you subscribe to the  
OnStar services, please refer to the OnStar Terms and  
Conditions for information on data collection and use.  
8-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Frequency  
Radio Frequency Statement  
Identification (RFID)  
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and with  
RSS-210/211 of Industry and Science Canada.  
RFID technology is used in some vehicles for functions  
such as tire pressure monitoring and ignition system  
security, as well as in connection with conveniences  
such as key fobs for remote door locking/unlocking and  
starting, and in-vehicle transmitters for garage door  
openers. RFID technology in GM vehicles does not use  
or record personal information or link with any other GM  
system containing personal information.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. The device may not cause interference.  
2. The device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Changes or modifications to any of these systems by  
other than an authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
8-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Antenna  
A
Backglass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Fixed Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-4  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Appearance Care  
Aluminum Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-79  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Assistance Program, Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Accessory Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7  
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Airbag  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-71  
Airbag System  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-65  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . 2-64  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-62  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60  
Airbags  
Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
i - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Radio with CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45  
Radio with Six-Disc CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Automatic Transmission  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . 6-47  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker and Parking  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43, 6-44  
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Sidemarker,  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
B
Stoplamps, and Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Backglass Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-66  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Inadvertent Power Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Brake  
C
California  
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5  
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7  
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Carbon Monoxide  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
i - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Care of  
Cleaning  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
CD, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . . 6-47  
Central Door Unlock System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-6  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Check  
Engine Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Child Restraints  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 2-44  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42  
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Aluminum Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-80  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-79  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-81  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Clutch, Hydraulic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Computer, Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
i - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Coolant  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Door  
Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Ajar Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Driver  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Engine Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Customer Information  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Driving  
At Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Before a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11  
In Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2  
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12  
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Daytime Running Lamps Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2  
Disc, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
i - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
E
EDR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Electrical System  
F
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . . . . . 6-87  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Engine  
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Change Engine Oil Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Check and Service Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-24  
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-32  
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-30  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
Engine Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Engine Oil  
Filter  
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Flat Tire, Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Flat Tire, Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Fluid  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20  
Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Fog Lamps  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-6  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
i - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuel (cont.)  
H
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37  
Fuel Economy  
Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
Fuses  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Instrument Panel Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-2  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-44  
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-43  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Front Turn Signal, Sidemarker and Parking  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Height Adjuster, Driver Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11  
Hold Mode Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Hood  
Checking Things Under . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-11  
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-12  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
G
Gasoline  
Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Gauges  
Engine Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
i - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
I
L
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Inadvertent Power Battery Saver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Instrument Panel  
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Lamps  
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
LATCH System for Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44  
Liftgate  
Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22  
Integrated Trailer Brake Control System (ITBC) . . . . 5-23  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2  
Carbon Monoxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Lights  
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Change Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Daytime Running Lamps Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36  
Exterior Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
J
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-38  
K
Keyless Entry  
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-2  
i - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights (cont.)  
M
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Highbeam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Hold Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Low Fuel Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37  
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Up-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Loading Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Locks  
Central Door Unlocking System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-8  
Low Fuel Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44  
Lumbar  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-15  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Manual Lumbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4  
Manual Transmission  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Manual Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Mirrors  
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Outside Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Outside Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Manual Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
i - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
N
P
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Paint, Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-85  
Park  
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Parking  
O
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Off-Road  
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Parking Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-65  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-7  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements, California . . . . . .6-5  
Power  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-32  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Pregnancy, Using Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
OnStar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Program  
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7  
Oil  
Change Engine Oil Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-18  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5  
OnStar, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Outlets  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Outside  
Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Manual Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-35  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-9  
Owners, Canadian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Proposition 65 Warning, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
i - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reporting Safety Defects  
R
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Restraint System Check  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-72  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-73  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Roof  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20  
Radios  
AM-FM Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Radio with CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-45  
Radio with Six-Disc CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-53  
Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-65  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7  
Rear Seat Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8, 2-10  
Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8  
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-11  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Reimbursement Program, GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-7  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3, 3-4  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
S
Safety Belts  
Care of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-82  
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Safety Belts Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-31  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-49  
Replacement Parts  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
i - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Defects Reporting  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Shifting  
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-30  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Spare Tire  
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-93  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5  
Steering Wheel Controls, Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-64  
Steering Wheel, Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Safety Warnings and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Seats  
Driver Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Manual Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Rear Seat Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8, 2-10  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Rear Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-51  
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the Vehicle . . . 6-6  
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
i - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires (cont.)  
T
Installing the Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-59  
Removing the Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-73  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-55  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Towing  
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23  
Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Transmission  
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-20  
Fluid, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Transmission Operation, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Taillamps  
Turn Signal, Sidemarker, Stoplamps, and  
Back-Up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-15  
Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-51  
Aluminum Wheels, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-70  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-84  
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-58  
Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-62  
i - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Transmission Operation, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-26  
Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Trip Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Trunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-8  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-86  
Ventilation Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-19  
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-14  
W
U
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Warnings  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Safety and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Wheels  
Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-66  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-68  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Where to Put the Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42  
V
Vehicle  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Parking Your . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-33  
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
i - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Windshield  
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-33  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
Windshield (cont.)  
Wiper Blades, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-83  
Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12  
Wipers  
Rear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
X
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63  
i - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Black Decker Laminate Trimmer 3270 User Manual
Blanco Indoor Furnishings 157 094 User Manual
Blanco Indoor Furnishings 513 689 User Manual
Cabletron Systems Indoor Fireplace 9F106 01 User Manual
Cambridge Audio DVD Player 540D V2 User Manual
Campbell Hausfeld Nail Gun CHN20103 User Manual
Campbell Hausfeld Paint Sprayer DH6500 User Manual
Canon Digital Camera 300MMF User Manual
Canon Photo Scanner CanoScan LiDe 50 User Manual
Canon Printer Accessories IP 1000 User Manual